blob: fb3e691d5f9db9e1fd131f120da860a15d9d36da [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue59fcdd2016-11-25 16:39:17 +01007 2016/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - tune.buffers.limit
594 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200596 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100597 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100598 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200599 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100600 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100602 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100603 - tune.lua.session-timeout
604 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200605 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100606 - tune.maxaccept
607 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200608 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200609 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200610 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100611 - tune.rcvbuf.client
612 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100613 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.sndbuf.client
615 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100616 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200618 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100619 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200620 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200621 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100622 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200623 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100624 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200625 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
626 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
627 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100628 - tune.zlib.memlevel
629 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631 * Debugging
632 - debug
633 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634
635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006363.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637------------------------------------
638
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639ca-base <dir>
640 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200641 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
642 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644chroot <jail dir>
645 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
646 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
647 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
648 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
649 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
650 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100651
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100652cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
653 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
654 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
655 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100656 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
657 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
658 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
659 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
660 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
661 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
662 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
663 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
664 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
665 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100666
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200667crt-base <dir>
668 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
669 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
670 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672daemon
673 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
674 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
675 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
676
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200677deviceatlas-json-file <path>
678 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
679 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
680
681deviceatlas-log-level <value>
682 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
683 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
684
685deviceatlas-separator <char>
686 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
687 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
688
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100689deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200690 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
691 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
692 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900694external-check
695 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
696 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
697 See "option external-check".
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699gid <number>
700 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
701 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
702 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100703 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
704 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100707hard-stop-after <time>
708 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
709
710 Arguments :
711 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
712 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
713 SIGUSR1 signal.
714
715 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
716 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
717 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
718
719 Example:
720 global
721 hard-stop-after 30s
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723group <group name>
724 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
725 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100726
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
729 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100730 configured with "log global".
731
732 <address> can be one of:
733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100734 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
736 port).
737
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100738 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
739 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
740 port).
741
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100742 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
743 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
744 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
745 writeable).
746
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200747 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
748 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100749
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200750 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
751 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
752 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
753 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
754 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
755 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
756 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
757 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
758 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
759 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
760 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
761
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200762 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
763 one of the following :
764
765 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
766 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
767
768 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
769 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
770
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100771 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
773 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
774 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
775 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
776
777 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200778 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
779 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
780 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
781 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
782 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
783 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200785 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100787log-send-hostname [<string>]
788 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
789 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
790 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
791 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
792 the logs.
793
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000794log-tag <string>
795 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
796 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
797 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100798 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100800lua-load <file>
801 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
802 used multiple times.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804nbproc <number>
805 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
806 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
807 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
808 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
809 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
810
811pidfile <pidfile>
812 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
813 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
814 starting the process. See also "daemon".
815
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100816presetenv <name> <value>
817 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
818 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
819 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
820 and "unsetenv".
821
822resetenv [<name> ...]
823 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
824 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
825 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
826 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
827 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
828 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
829 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
830 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
831
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100832stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200833 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
834 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
835 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
836 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
837 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
838 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100839 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200840 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
841 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200842
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200843server-state-base <directory>
844 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200845 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
846 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200847
848server-state-file <file>
849 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
850 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
851 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
852 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
853 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
854 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
855 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
856 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200857 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
858 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200859
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100860setenv <name> <value>
861 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
862 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
863 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
864 and "unsetenv".
865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100866ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300869 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100870 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
871 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
872 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
873 "bind" keyword for more information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
880 Example:
881 global
882 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
886 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
889 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
890 information.
891
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100892ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
894 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
895 keyword to see available options.
896
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200897ssl-dh-param-file <file>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
900 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
901 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
902 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200903 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
904 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
905 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
906 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200907 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
908 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
909 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
910
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100911ssl-server-verify [none|required]
912 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
913 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
914 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
915
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200916stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
917 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
918 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
919 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200920 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
921 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200922
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200923 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
924 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
925 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200926
927stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
928 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
929 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100930 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200931
932stats maxconn <connections>
933 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
934 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936uid <number>
937 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
938 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
939 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
940 one. See also "gid" and "user".
941
942ulimit-n <number>
943 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
944 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
945 option.
946
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100947unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
948 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
949
950 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
951 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
952 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
953 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
954 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
955 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
956 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
957 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
958 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
959 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
960
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100961unsetenv [<name> ...]
962 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
963 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
964 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
965 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
966 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
967 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
968 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970user <user name>
971 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
972 See also "uid" and "group".
973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200974node <name>
975 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
976
977 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
978 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
979 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
980 traffic.
981
982description <text>
983 Add a text that describes the instance.
984
985 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
986 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
987 "<" and ">" characters.
988
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010098951degrees-data-file <file path>
990 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
991 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
992
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200993 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100994 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
995
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
998 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
999 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1000
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001001 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001002 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1003
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001005 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1006 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1007
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1009 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1010
101151degrees-cache-size <number>
1012 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1013 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1014 By default, this cache is disabled.
1015
1016 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1018
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001019wurfl-data-file <file path>
1020 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1021 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1022
1023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1024 with USE_WURFL=1.
1025
1026wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1027 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1028 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1029 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1030
1031 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1032
1033 Valid WURFL properties are:
1034 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1035
1036 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1037 device.
1038
1039 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1040 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1041
1042 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1043 particular web request.
1044
1045 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1046 used Libwurfl API version.
1047
1048 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1049 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1050 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1051
1052 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1053 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1054
1055 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1056 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1057
1058 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1061
1062 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1063 with USE_WURFL=1.
1064
1065wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1066 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1067 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1068
1069 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1070 with USE_WURFL=1.
1071
1072wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1073 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1074 thus before the chroot.
1075
1076 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1077 with USE_WURFL=1.
1078
1079wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1080 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1081 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1082 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1083 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1084 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1085 mode is enabled by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1091 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1092 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1093 - "0" : no cache is used.
1094 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1095 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1096 the highest performing option.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1102 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1103 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110-----------------------
1111
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001112max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1113 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1114 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1115 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1116 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1117 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1118 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1119 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1120 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122maxconn <number>
1123 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1124 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1125 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001126 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1127 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1128 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1129 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001130 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1131 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1132 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1133 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1134 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001136maxconnrate <number>
1137 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1138 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1139 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1140 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1141 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1142 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1143 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1144 fairness.
1145
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001146maxcomprate <number>
1147 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001148 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001149 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1150 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1151 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1152 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1153 default value.
1154
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001155maxcompcpuusage <number>
1156 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1157 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1158 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1159 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1160 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1161 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1162 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1163 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1164
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001165maxpipes <number>
1166 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1167 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1168 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1169 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1170 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1171 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1172
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001173maxsessrate <number>
1174 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1175 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1176 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1177 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1178 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1179 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1180 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1181 fairness.
1182
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001183maxsslconn <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1185 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1186 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1187 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1188 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1189 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1190 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001191 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1192 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1193 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1194 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1195 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1196 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1197 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001198
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001199maxsslrate <number>
1200 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1201 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1202 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1203 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1204 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1205 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1206 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1207 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1208 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1209 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1210
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001211maxzlibmem <number>
1212 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1213 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1214 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001215 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1216 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1217 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219noepoll
1220 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1221 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001222 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001223
1224nokqueue
1225 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1226 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1227 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1228
1229nopoll
1230 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1231 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001233 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001235nosplice
1236 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1237 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1238 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001239 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001240 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1241 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1242 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1243 "option splice-response".
1244
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001245nogetaddrinfo
1246 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1247 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1248
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001249noreuseport
1250 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1251 command line argument "-dR".
1252
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001253spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001254 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1255 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1256 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1257 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1258 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1259 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001261tune.buffers.limit <number>
1262 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1263 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1264 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1265 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1266 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1267 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1268 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1269 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1270 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1271 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1272 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1273 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1274 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1275 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1276 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1277
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001278tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1279 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1280 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1281 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1282 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1283
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001284tune.bufsize <number>
1285 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1286 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1287 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1288 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1289 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1290 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1291 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1292 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001293 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1294 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1295 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001296
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001297tune.chksize <number>
1298 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1299 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1300 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1301 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1302 checks whenever possible.
1303
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001304tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1305 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1306 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1307 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1308 this value. The default value is 1.
1309
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001310tune.http.cookielen <number>
1311 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1312 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1313 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1314 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1315 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1316 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1317 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1318 to change this value.
1319
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001320tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1321 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1322 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1323 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1324 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1325 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1326 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1327 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1328 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1329 limit too high.
1330
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001331tune.idletimer <timeout>
1332 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1333 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1334 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1335 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1336 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1337 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1338 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1339 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1340 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1341
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1343 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001344 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1346 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1347 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1348 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1349 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1350
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001351tune.lua.maxmem
1352 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1353 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1354 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1355 memory.
1356
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001357tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1358 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001359 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1360 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1361 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001362
1363tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1364 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1365 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1366 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1367 check servers.
1368
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001369tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1370 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1371 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1372 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1373 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1374
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001375tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001376 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1377 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1378 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1379 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1380 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1381 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1382 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1383 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1384 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1385 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001386
1387tune.maxpollevents <number>
1388 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1389 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1390 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1391 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1392 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1393
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001394tune.maxrewrite <number>
1395 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1396 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1397 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1398 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1399 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1400 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1401 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1402 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1403 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1404 bufsize.
1405
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001406tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1407 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1408 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1409 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1410 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1411 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1412 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1413 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1414 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1415 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1416 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1417 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1418 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1419 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1420 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1421 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1422 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1423 setting this parameter to 0.
1424
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001425tune.pipesize <number>
1426 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1427 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1428 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1429 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1430 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1431 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1434tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1436 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001443tune.recv_enough <number>
1444 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1445 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1446 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1447 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1448 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1449
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001450tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1451tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1452 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1453 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1454 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1455 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1456 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1457 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1458 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1459 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1460 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1461 notifying haproxy again.
1462
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001463tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001464 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1465 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1466 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001467 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001468 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1469 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1470 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1471 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1472 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001473 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1474 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001475
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001476tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1477 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1478 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1479 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1480 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1481 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1482 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1483
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001484tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1485 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001486 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001487 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1488 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1489 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1490 being used for too long.
1491
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001492tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1493 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1494 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1495 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1496 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1497 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1498 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1499 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1500 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1501 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1502 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001503 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1504 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001505
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001506tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1508 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1509 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1510 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1511 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1512 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1513 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001514 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1515 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001516
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001517tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1518 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1519 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1520 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1521 1000 entries.
1522
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001523tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1524 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1525 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1526 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001528tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001529tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001530tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1531tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1532tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001533 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1534 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1535 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1536 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1537 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1538 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1539 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1540 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001541
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001542 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1543 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1544 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1545 all available space is consumed.
1546 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1547 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1548 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001549
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001550tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1551 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001552 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001553 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1554 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1555 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1556
1557tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1558 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1559 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1560 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1561 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015633.3. Debugging
1564--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001565
1566debug
1567 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1568 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1569 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1570 system startup.
1571
1572quiet
1573 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1574 line argument "-q".
1575
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015773.4. Userlists
1578--------------
1579It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1580http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1581it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1582
1583userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001584 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001585 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1586
1587group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001588 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1590 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1591
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001592user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1593 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001594 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1595 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001596 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1597 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001598 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001599 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001600
1601
1602 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001603 userlist L1
1604 group G1 users tiger,scott
1605 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001606
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001607 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1608 user scott insecure-password elgato
1609 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001610
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001611 userlist L2
1612 group G1
1613 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001614
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001615 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1616 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1617 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001618
1619 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001621
16223.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001624It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1625several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1626instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1627values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1628automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1629In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1630using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1631tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1632reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1633Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1634that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1635each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001636
1637peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001638 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001639 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1640
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001641disabled
1642 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1643 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1644 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1645
1646enable
1647 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1648
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001649peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1650 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1651 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1652 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1653 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1654 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1655 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1656
1657 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1658 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1659
1660 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1661 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1662 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1663 across all peers.
1664
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001665 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1666 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001668 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001669 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001670 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1671 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1672 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001673
1674 backend mybackend
1675 mode tcp
1676 balance roundrobin
1677 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1678 stick on src
1679
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001680 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1681 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001682
1683
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016843.6. Mailers
1685------------
1686It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1687If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1688in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1689
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001690mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001691 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1692 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1693
1694mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1695 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 mailers mymailers
1699 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1700 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1701
1702 backend mybackend
1703 mode tcp
1704 balance roundrobin
1705
1706 email-alert mailers mymailers
1707 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1708 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1709
1710 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1711 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1712
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001713timeout mail <time>
1714 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1715 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1716 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1717 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 mailers mymailers
1721 timeout mail 20s
1722 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001728 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729 - frontend <name>
1730 - backend <name>
1731 - listen <name>
1732
1733A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1734its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1735section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
1738A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1739connections.
1740
1741A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1742to forward incoming connections.
1743
1744A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1745parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1748'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1749case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1750
1751Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1752logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1753proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1754However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1755name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1756
1757Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1758and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001759bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1761modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1762arbitrary criteria.
1763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001764In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1765a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1766the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1767
1768 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1769 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1770 between responses and new requests.
1771
1772 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1773 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1774 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1775 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1776
1777 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1778 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1779 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1780
1781 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1782 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1783 client-facing connection remains open.
1784
1785 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1786 after the end of the response.
1787
1788The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1789frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1790following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1791weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1792
1793 Backend mode
1794
1795 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1796 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1797 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1798 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1799 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1800 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1801 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1802 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1803 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1804 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1805 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1810--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001812The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1813limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1814they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1815limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001816marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001817option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001818and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1819with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1820specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001822
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1824------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1825acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001826appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827backlog X X X -
1828balance X - X X
1829bind - X X -
1830bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001831block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832capture cookie - X X -
1833capture request header - X X -
1834capture response header - X X -
1835clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001836compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001837contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1838cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001839declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001840default-server X - X X
1841default_backend X X X -
1842description - X X X
1843disabled X X X X
1844dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001845email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001846email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001847email-alert mailers X X X X
1848email-alert myhostname X X X X
1849email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850enabled X X X X
1851errorfile X X X X
1852errorloc X X X X
1853errorloc302 X X X X
1854-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1855errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001856force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001857filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001858fullconn X - X X
1859grace X X X X
1860hash-type X - X X
1861http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001862http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001863http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001864http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001865http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001866http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001867http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001868id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001869ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001870load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001871log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001872log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001873log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001874log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001875max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876maxconn X X X -
1877mode X X X X
1878monitor fail - X X -
1879monitor-net X X X -
1880monitor-uri X X X -
1881option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1882option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1883option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1884option allbackups (*) X - X X
1885option checkcache (*) X - X X
1886option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1887option contstats (*) X X X -
1888option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1889option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1890option forceclose (*) X X X X
1891-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1892option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001893option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001894option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001895option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001896option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001897option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001898option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001899option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1901option httpchk X - X X
1902option httpclose (*) X X X X
1903option httplog X X X X
1904option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001905option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001906option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1909option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1910option logasap (*) X X X -
1911option mysql-check X - X X
1912option nolinger (*) X X X X
1913option originalto X X X X
1914option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001915option pgsql-check X - X X
1916option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001917option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001918option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919option smtpchk X - X X
1920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1922option splice-request (*) X X X X
1923option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001924option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001925option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1926option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1927-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001928option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001929option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1930option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1931option tcpka X X X X
1932option tcplog X X X X
1933option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001934external-check command X - X X
1935external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1937rate-limit sessions X X X -
1938redirect - X X X
1939redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1940redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1941reqadd - X X X
1942reqallow - X X X
1943reqdel - X X X
1944reqdeny - X X X
1945reqiallow - X X X
1946reqidel - X X X
1947reqideny - X X X
1948reqipass - X X X
1949reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001950reqitarpit - X X X
1951reqpass - X X X
1952reqrep - X X X
1953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954reqtarpit - X X X
1955retries X - X X
1956rspadd - X X X
1957rspdel - X X X
1958rspdeny - X X X
1959rspidel - X X X
1960rspideny - X X X
1961rspirep - X X X
1962rsprep - X X X
1963server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001964server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965source X - X X
1966srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001967stats admin - X X X
1968stats auth X X X X
1969stats enable X X X X
1970stats hide-version X X X X
1971stats http-request - X X X
1972stats realm X X X X
1973stats refresh X X X X
1974stats scope X X X X
1975stats show-desc X X X X
1976stats show-legends X X X X
1977stats show-node X X X X
1978stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1980stick match - - X X
1981stick on - - X X
1982stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001983stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001984stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001985tcp-check connect - - X X
1986tcp-check expect - - X X
1987tcp-check send - - X X
1988tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001989tcp-request connection - X X -
1990tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001991tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001992tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001993tcp-response content - - X X
1994tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995timeout check X - X X
1996timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001997timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1999timeout connect X - X X
2000timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2001timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2002timeout http-request X X X X
2003timeout queue X - X X
2004timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002005timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002006timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2007timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002008timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002010unique-id-format X X X -
2011unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002013use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2015 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2019---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2022
2023
2024acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2025 Declare or complete an access list.
2026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2027 no | yes | yes | yes
2028 Example:
2029 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2030 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2031 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002033 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034
2035
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002036appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2037 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 no | no | yes | yes
2041 Arguments :
2042 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2043 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2044
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002045 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 checked in each cookie value.
2047
2048 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2049 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2050 milliseconds.
2051
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002052 request-learn
2053 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2054 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2055 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2056 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2057 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2058 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2059
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002060 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2061 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2062 data following this prefix.
2063
2064 Example :
2065 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2066
2067 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2068 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2069
2070 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2071 2 modes are currently supported :
2072 - path-parameters :
2073 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2074 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2075 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2076 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2077 - query-string :
2078 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2079 query string.
2080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002081 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2082 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2083 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002085 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2086 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087
2088
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002089backlog <conns>
2090 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 yes | yes | yes | no
2093 Arguments :
2094 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2095 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002097
2098 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2099 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2100 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2101 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2102 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2103 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2104 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2105 backlog parameter.
2106
2107 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2108 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2109 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2110
2111 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2112
2113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002115balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | no | yes | yes
2119 Arguments :
2120 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2121 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2122 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2123 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2124
2125 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2126 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2127 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2128 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002129 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002130 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002131 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2132 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2133 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2134 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2135 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2136 it, so that you don't worry.
2137
2138 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2139 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2140 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2141 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2142 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2143 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2144 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2145 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002147 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2148 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2149 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2150 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2151 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2152 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2153 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2154 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2155
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002156 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002157 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002158 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2159 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002160 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002161 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2162 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2163 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2164 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2165 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002166 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2167 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2168 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2169 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2170 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2171 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2174 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2175 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2176 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2177 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2178 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2179 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2180 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002181 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002183 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2184 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2185 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002187 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2188 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2189 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2190 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2191 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2192 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2193 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2194 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2195 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2196 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2197 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2198 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002200 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002201 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2202 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2203 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2204 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2205 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2206 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2207 URIs start with a leading "/".
2208
2209 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2210 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2211 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2212 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002215 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2216
2217 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002218 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2219 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002220 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2221 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2222 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2223 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002224 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002225 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2226 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002227
2228 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2229 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2230 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2231 server will receive the request.
2232
2233 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2234 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2235 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2236 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2237 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002238 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2239 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2240 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002242 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2243 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2244 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2245 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2246 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002249 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2250 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2251 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2252
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002253 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2254 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2255 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2256
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002257 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002258 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002259 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2260 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2261 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2262 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2263 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2264 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002265 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002266 used instead.
2267
2268 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2269 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2270 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2271 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2272
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002273 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2274 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2275 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2276
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002277 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002280 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2281 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002283 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2284 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2285 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286
2287 Examples :
2288 balance roundrobin
2289 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002291 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2292 balance hdr(host)
2293 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002294
2295 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2296 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002298 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002299 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2300 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2301 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2302 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2303
2304 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2305 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2306 defaults to 16 kB.
2307
2308 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2309 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2310
2311 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2312 Round Robin.
2313
2314 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2315 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2316 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2317 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2318
2319 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2320
2321 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002322 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002323 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2324 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2325 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002327 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328
2329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002330bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2331bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2334 no | yes | yes | no
2335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002336 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2337 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2338 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2339 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002340 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002341 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2342 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2343 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2344 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2345 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2346 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2347 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002348 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2349 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2350 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2351 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2352 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2353 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2354 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002355 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2356 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2357 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2359 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2360 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002361
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002362 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2363 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002364 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2365 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2366 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002367 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2368 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2369 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2370 the range.
2371
2372 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2373 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2374 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2375 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2376 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2377 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2378 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002379 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002380 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002382 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2383 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2384 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2385 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2386 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2387 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2388 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2389 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002391 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2392 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2393 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2394 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2397 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2398 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2399 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2400 in a frontend.
2401
2402 Example :
2403 listen http_proxy
2404 bind :80,:443
2405 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002406 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002408 listen http_https_proxy
2409 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002410 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002411
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002412 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2413 bind ipv6@:80
2414 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2415 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2416
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002417 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002418 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002419
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002420 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2421 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2422 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2423 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2424 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2425
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002426 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002427 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
2429
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002431 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2436 may be used to override a default value.
2437
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002438 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002439 option may be combined with other numbers.
2440
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002441 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002442 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2443 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2444 missing from all processes.
2445
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002446 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002447 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002448 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2449 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2450 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2451 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002452
2453 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2454 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2455 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2456 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2457 and 'even' instances.
2458
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002459 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2460 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2461 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2462 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2465 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2466
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002467 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2468 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2469 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2470
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002471 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2472 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2473
2474 Example :
2475 listen app_ip1
2476 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002477 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002478
2479 listen app_ip2
2480 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002481 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002482
2483 listen management
2484 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002485 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002487 listen management
2488 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2489 bind-process 1-4
2490
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002491 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002492
2493
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002494block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 no | yes | yes | yes
2498
2499 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2500 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002502 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2504 "block" statements per instance.
2505
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002506 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2507 "http-request deny" instead.
2508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002509 Example:
2510 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2511 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2512 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2513 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517
2518capture cookie <name> len <length>
2519 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 no | yes | yes | no
2522 Arguments :
2523 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2524 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2525 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2526 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2527 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2528
2529 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2530 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2531 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2532 right if it exceeds <length>.
2533
2534 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2535 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2536 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2537 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2538
2539 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2540 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2541 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2542
2543 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2544 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2545 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2547 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2548 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549
2550 Example:
2551 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2552
2553 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002554 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555
2556
2557capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002558 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 no | yes | yes | no
2561 Arguments :
2562 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002563 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2565 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2566 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2567
2568 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2569 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2570 it exceeds <length>.
2571
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002572 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2574 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002575 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2576 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2577 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2578 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002579 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002580 environments to find where the request came from.
2581
2582 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2583 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2584 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2585 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002587 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2588 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2589 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2590 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2591 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592
2593 Example:
2594 capture request header Host len 15
2595 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002596 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002598 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599 about logging.
2600
2601
2602capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002603 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 no | yes | yes | no
2606 Arguments :
2607 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002608 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2610 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2611 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2612
2613 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2614 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2615 it exceeds <length>.
2616
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002617 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2619 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2620 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002621 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2622 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2623 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2624 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002626 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2627 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2628 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2629 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2630 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631
2632 Example:
2633 capture response header Content-length len 9
2634 capture response header Location len 15
2635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002636 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 about logging.
2638
2639
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002640clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | yes | yes | no
2644 Arguments :
2645 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2646 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2647 as explained at the top of this document.
2648
2649 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2650 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2651 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2652 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2653 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2654 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2655 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2656 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002657 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2659 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2660
2661 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2663 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2664 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2665 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2666 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2667
2668 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2669 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2670
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002671 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2672 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002674compression algo <algorithm> ...
2675compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002676compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002677 Enable HTTP compression.
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | yes | yes | yes
2680 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002681 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2682 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2683 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2684
2685 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002686 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2687 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2688 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002689
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002690 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002691 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002692
2693 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2694 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2695 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2696 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2697 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002698 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002699
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002700 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2701 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2702 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2703 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2704 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2705 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2706 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002707 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002708
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002709 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002710 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002711 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2712 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2713 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2714 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2715 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002716
2717 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2718 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2719 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2720 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2721 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002722 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2723 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2724 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2725 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2726 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002727 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2728 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002729
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002730 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002731 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2732 "Accept-Encoding" header
2733 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002734 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002735 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2736 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002737 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2738 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2739 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2740 "multipart"
2741 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2742 header
2743 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2744 and later
2745 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2746 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002747
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002748 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2749 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002750
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002751 Examples :
2752 compression algo gzip
2753 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002755
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002756contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2759 yes | no | yes | yes
2760 Arguments :
2761 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2763 as explained at the top of this document.
2764
2765 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002766 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002767 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002768 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2769 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2770 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2771 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2772
2773 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2774 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2775 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2776 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2777 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2778 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2779
2780 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2781 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2782 instead.
2783
2784 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2785 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2786
2787
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002788cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002789 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2790 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002791 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | no | yes | yes
2795 Arguments :
2796 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2797 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2798 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2799 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2800 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2801 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2802 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2803 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2804 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2805
2806 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2807 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2808 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2809 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2810 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2811 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002812 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2813 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2814 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2815 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2816 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
2818 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002819 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002820
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002821 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002822 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2823 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2824 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2825 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2826 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2827 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2828 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2829 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2830 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2831 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
2833 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2834 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2835 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2836 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2837 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2838 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2839 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2840 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2841 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002842 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002843 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2844 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2845 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002847 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2848 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2849 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002850 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2851 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2852 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2853 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002854 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2855 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2856 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
2858 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2859 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2860 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2861 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2862 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2863 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2864 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2865 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2866 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2867
2868 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2869 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2870 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2871 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2872 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2873 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2874 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2875 persistence cookie in the cache.
2876 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2877
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002878 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2879 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2880 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2881 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2882 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2883 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2884 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2885 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2886 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2887 they logout.
2888
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002889 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2890 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2891 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2892 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2893
2894 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2895 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2896 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2897 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2898 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2899 this attribute.
2900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002901 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002903 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2904 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2905 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2906 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2907 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2908 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002910 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2911 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2912 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2913 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2914 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2915 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2916 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2917 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2918 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2919 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2920 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2921 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2922 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2923 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2924 the site.
2925
2926 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2927 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2928 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2929 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2930 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2931 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2932 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2933 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2934 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2935 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2936 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2937 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2938 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2939 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2940 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2941 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2942
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002943 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2944 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2945 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2946 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2947 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2948 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2951 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2952 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2953 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955 Examples :
2956 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2957 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2958 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002959 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002961 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002963
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002964declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2965 Declares a capture slot.
2966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2967 no | yes | yes | no
2968 Arguments:
2969 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2970
2971 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2972 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2973 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2974 for use in the response.
2975
2976 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002977 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002978 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2979
2980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002981default-server [param*]
2982 Change default options for a server in a backend
2983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2984 yes | no | yes | yes
2985 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002986 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2987 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2988 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2989 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002990
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002991 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002992 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2993
2994 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002995
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997default_backend <backend>
2998 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | no
3001 Arguments :
3002 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3003
3004 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3005 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3006 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3007 will catch all undetermined requests.
3008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 Example :
3010
3011 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3012 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3013 default_backend dynamic
3014
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003015 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003017
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003018description <string>
3019 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 no | yes | yes | yes
3022 Arguments : string
3023
3024 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3025 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3026 it describes.
3027 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3028
3029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030disabled
3031 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3033 yes | yes | yes | yes
3034 Arguments : none
3035
3036 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3037 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3038 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3039 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3040 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3041 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3042 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3043
3044 See also : "enabled"
3045
3046
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003047dispatch <address>:<port>
3048 Set a default server address
3049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003052
3053 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3054 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3055 during start-up.
3056
3057 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3058 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3059 possible with normal servers.
3060
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003061 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003062 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3063 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3064 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3065 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3066
3067 See also : "server"
3068
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003069
3070dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3071 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 yes | no | yes | yes
3074 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3075
3076 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3077 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3078 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3079 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3080 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3081 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083enabled
3084 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 yes | yes | yes | yes
3087 Arguments : none
3088
3089 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3090 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3091
3092 See also : "disabled"
3093
3094
3095errorfile <code> <file>
3096 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3098 yes | yes | yes | yes
3099 Arguments :
3100 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003101 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3102 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103
3104 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003105 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003107 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3108 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
3110 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3111 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3112 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3113
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003114 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3117 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3118 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3119 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3120
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003121 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3122 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3123 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3124 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3125 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3126 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3129 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3130 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003131 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3133
3134 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3135
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003136 Example :
3137 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003138 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003139 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3140 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3141
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003142
3143errorloc <code> <url>
3144errorloc302 <code> <url>
3145 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | yes | yes | yes
3148 Arguments :
3149 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003150 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003151
3152 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3153 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3154 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3155 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3156 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3157
3158 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3159 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3160 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3161
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003162 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3163
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3165 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3166 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3167 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003168 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003169 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3170 request.
3171
3172 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3173
3174
3175errorloc303 <code> <url>
3176 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | yes
3179 Arguments :
3180 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3181 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3182
3183 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3184 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3185 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3186 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3187 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3188
3189 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3190 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3191 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3192
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003193 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3196 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3197 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3198 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003199 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003200
3201 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3202
3203
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003204email-alert from <emailaddr>
3205 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3206 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | yes
3209
3210 Arguments :
3211
3212 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3213
3214 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3215 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3216
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003217 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003218 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3219 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003220
3221
3222email-alert level <level>
3223 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3224 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3226 yes | yes | yes | yes
3227
3228 Arguments :
3229
3230 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3231 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3232 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3233
3234 By default level is alert
3235
3236 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3237 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3238 for the proxy.
3239
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003240 Alerts are sent when :
3241
3242 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3243 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3244 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3245 is notice or lower
3246 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3247 and a health check status update occurs
3248
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003249 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3250 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003251 section 3.6 about mailers.
3252
3253
3254email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3255 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | yes
3258
3259 Arguments :
3260
3261 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3262
3263 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3264 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3265
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003266 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3267 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003268
3269
3270email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3271 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3272 mailers.
3273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | yes | yes | yes
3275
3276 Arguments :
3277
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003278 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003279
3280 By default the systems hostname is used.
3281
3282 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3283 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3284 for the proxy.
3285
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003286 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3287 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003288
3289
3290email-alert to <emailaddr>
3291 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3292 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 yes | yes | yes | yes
3295
3296 Arguments :
3297
3298 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3299
3300 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3301 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3302
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003303 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003304 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3305
3306
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003307force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3308 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 no | yes | yes | yes
3311
3312 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3313 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3314 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3315 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3316 marked down for maintenance operations.
3317
3318 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3319 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3320 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3321 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3322 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3323 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3324 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3325 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3326 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3327
3328 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3329 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3330 is used.
3331
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003332 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003333 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003334
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003335
3336filter <name> [param*]
3337 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3339 no | yes | yes | yes
3340 Arguments :
3341 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3342 referenced in section 9.
3343
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003344 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003345 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003346 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3347 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003348
3349 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3350 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3351
3352 Example:
3353 listen
3354 bind *:80
3355
3356 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3357 filter compression
3358 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3359
3360 compression algo gzip
3361 compression offload
3362
3363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3364
3365 See also : section 9.
3366
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368fullconn <conns>
3369 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3371 yes | no | yes | yes
3372 Arguments :
3373 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3374 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3375
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003376 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003377 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003378 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003379 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3380 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3381 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3382 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3383 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003384 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003386 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3387 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003388 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3389 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3390 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392 Example :
3393 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3394 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3395 # connections.
3396 backend dynamic
3397 fullconn 10000
3398 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3399 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3400
3401 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3402
3403
3404grace <time>
3405 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003408 Arguments :
3409 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3410 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3411 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3412
3413 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3414 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003415 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3417
3418 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3419 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3420 simplify it.
3421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003423hash-balance-factor <factor>
3424 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 yes | no | no | yes
3427 Arguments :
3428 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3429 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3430 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3431
3432 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3433 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3434 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3435 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3436 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3437 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3438 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3439
3440 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3441 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3442 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3443 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3444 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3445
3446 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3447
3448
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003449hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003450 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3452 yes | no | yes | yes
3453 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003454 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3455 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003456
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003457 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3458 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3459 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3460 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3461 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3462 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3463 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3464 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3465 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3466 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003467
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003468 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3469 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3470 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3471 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3472 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3473 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3474 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3475 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3476 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3477 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3478 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3479 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3480 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003481 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3482 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003483
3484 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003486 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003487 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3488 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3489 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003490 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3491 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3492 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003493
3494 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3495 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003496 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3497 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3498 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3499 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3500
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003501 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3502 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3503 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3504 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3505 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3506 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3507 parameter.
3508
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003509 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3510 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3511 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3512 used on strings.
3513
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003514 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3515
3516 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3517 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3518 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3519 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3520 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3521 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3522 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3523 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3524 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3525 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3526 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3527 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003528
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003529 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3530 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3531 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003532
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003533 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003534
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536http-check disable-on-404
3537 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003539 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3543 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3544 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3545 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3546 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3547 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3548 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3549 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003550 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3551 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3552 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3553
3554 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3555
3556
3557http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003558 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003560 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003561 Arguments :
3562 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3563 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003564 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003565 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3566 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3567 details on the supported keywords.
3568
3569 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3570 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3571 with the usual backslash ('\').
3572
3573 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3574 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3575 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3576 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3577 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3578
3579 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003581 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3582 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3583 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3584
3585 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003587 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3588 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3589 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3590 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3591
3592 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003593 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003594 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3595 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3596 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3597 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3598 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3599 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3600 trace).
3601
3602 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003603 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003604 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3605 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3606 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3607 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3608 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3609 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3610
3611 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3612 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3613 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3614 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3615 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3616 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3617 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3618 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3619
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003620 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3621 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3622 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3623
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003624 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3625 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3626
3627 Examples :
3628 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003629 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003630
3631 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003632 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003633
3634 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003635 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003636
3637 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003638 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003640 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003643http-check send-state
3644 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | no | yes | yes
3647 Arguments : none
3648
3649 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3650 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3651 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3652 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3653 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3654
3655 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3656 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3657 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3658 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3659 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003660 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3661 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3662 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3663
3664 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3665 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3666 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3667
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003668 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3669 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3670 checked in multiple backends.
3671
3672 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3673 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3674
3675 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3676 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3677 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3678 one fails.
3679
3680 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3681 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3682 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3683
3684 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3685 server's queue.
3686
3687 Example of a header received by the application server :
3688 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3689 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3690
3691 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3692
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003693http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3694 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003695 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003696 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003697 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003698 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3699 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003700 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3701 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003702 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3703 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3704 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003705 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003706 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003707 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003708 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003709 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003710 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003711 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003712 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003714 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3715
3716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 no | yes | yes | yes
3718
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003719 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3720 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3721 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3722 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3723 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003724
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003725 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3726 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3727 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3728
3729 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003730 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3731 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3732 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3733 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003734
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003735 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3736 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3737 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003738 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3739 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003740 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3741 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3742 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3743 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3744 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003745 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003746 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3747 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003748
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003749 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3750 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3751 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3752 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3753 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3754
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003755 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3756 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3757 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003758 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3759 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003760
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003761 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3762 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3763 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3764 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3765 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3766 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3767 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3768 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3769
3770 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3771 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3772 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003773 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3774 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003775
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003776 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3777 <name>.
3778
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003779 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3780 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3781 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3782 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3783 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3784 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3785 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3786 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3787
3788 Example:
3789
3790 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3791
3792 applied to:
3793
3794 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3795
3796 outputs:
3797
3798 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3799
3800 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3801
3802 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3803 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3804 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3805 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3806 header.
3807
3808 Example:
3809
3810 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3811
3812 applied to:
3813
3814 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3815
3816 outputs:
3817
3818 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3819
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003820 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3821 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3822 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3823 it.
3824
3825 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3826 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3827 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3828 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3829 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3830 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3831
3832 Example :
3833 # prepend the host name before the path
3834 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3835
3836 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3837 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3838 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3839 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3840 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3841 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3842 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3843 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3844
3845 Example :
3846 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3847 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3848
3849 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3850 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3851 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3852 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3853 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3854 "set-query".
3855
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003856 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3857 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3858 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3859 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3860 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3861 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3862 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3863 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3864
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003865 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3866 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3867 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3868 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3869 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3870 another equipment.
3871
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003872 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3873 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3874 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3875 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3876 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3877 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3878 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3879 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3880
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003881 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3882 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3883 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3884 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3885 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3886 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3887 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3888 admin privileges.
3889
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003890 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3891 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3892 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3893 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3894 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3895 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3896 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3897 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3898
3899 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3900 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3901 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3902 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3903 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3904 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3905
3906 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3907 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3908 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3909 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3910 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3911 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3912
3913 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3914 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3915 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3916 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3917 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3918 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3919 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3920 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3921 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3922
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003923 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003924 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3925 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3926 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3927 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3928 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3929 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3930 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3931 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3932 request header" for more information.
3933
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003934 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3935 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3936 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3937 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003938 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3939 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003940
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003941 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3942 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3943 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3944 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3945 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3946 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3947 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3948 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3949 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3950 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3951 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3952 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3953
3954 These actions take one or two arguments :
3955 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3956 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3957 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3958 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3959
3960 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3961 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3962 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3963 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3964
3965 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3966 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3967 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3968 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3969 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3970 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3971 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3972 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3973
3974 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3975 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3976 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3977 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3978 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003980 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3981 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3982 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3983 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3984 continues.
3985
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003986 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3987 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3988 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3989 the actions evaluation continues.
3990
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003991 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3992 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3993 inline.
3994
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003995 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3996 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004000 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004002 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4004 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004006 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004007 and '_'.
4008
4009 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4010 followed by some converters.
4011
4012 Example:
4013
4014 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4015
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004016 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4017 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4018
4019 Example:
4020
4021 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4022
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004023 - set-src <expr> :
4024 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4025 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4026 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4027 source IP for privacy.
4028
4029 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4030 followed by some converters.
4031
4032 Example:
4033
4034 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4035 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4036
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004037 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4038 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004039
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004040 - set-src-port <expr> :
4041 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4042 expression.
4043
4044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4045 followed by some converters.
4046
4047 Example:
4048
4049 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4050 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4051
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004052 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4053 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4054 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004055
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004056 - set-dst <expr> :
4057 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4058 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4059 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4060 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4061 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4062
4063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4064 followed by some converters.
4065
4066 Example:
4067
4068 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4069 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4070
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004071 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4072 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4073
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004074 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4075 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4076 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4077 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4078
4079 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4080 followed by some converters.
4081
4082 Example:
4083
4084 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4085 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4086
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004087 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4088 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4089 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4090
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004091 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4092 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4093 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4094 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4095 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4096 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4097 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4098 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4099 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4100 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4101 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4102 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4103 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4104 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4105 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4106 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4107
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004108 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4109
4110 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4111 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004112 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4113 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4114
4115 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4116 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4117 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4118 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004119
4120 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004121 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4122 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4123 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004124
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004125 http-request allow if nagios
4126 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4127 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4128 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004129
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004130 Example:
4131 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004132 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004133
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004134 Example:
4135 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4136 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004137 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4140 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4142 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4143 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4144
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004145 Example:
4146 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4147 acl add path /addacl
4148 acl del path /delacl
4149
4150 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4151
4152 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4153 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4154
4155 Example:
4156 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4157 acl setmap path /setmap
4158 acl delmap path /delmap
4159
4160 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4161
4162 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4163 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4164
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004165 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4166 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004167
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004168http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004169 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004170 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004171 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4172 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004173 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004174 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4175 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4176 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4177 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004178 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004179 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004180 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004181 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004182 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004183 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004184 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004185 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004186 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004187 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4188
4189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4190 no | yes | yes | yes
4191
4192 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4193 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4194 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4195 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4196 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4197 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4198
4199 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4200 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4201 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4202 current section.
4203
4204 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4205 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4206 rules are evaluated.
4207
4208 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4209 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4210 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4211 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4212 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4213 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4214 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4215
4216 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4217 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4218 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4219 external users.
4220
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004221 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4222 <name>.
4223
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4225 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4226 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4227 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4228 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4229 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4230 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4231 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4232
4233 Example:
4234
4235 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4236
4237 applied to:
4238
4239 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4240
4241 outputs:
4242
4243 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4244
4245 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4246
4247 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4248 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4249 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4250 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4251 header.
4252
4253 Example:
4254
4255 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4256
4257 applied to:
4258
4259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4260
4261 outputs:
4262
4263 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4264
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004265 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004266 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4267 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4268 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004269
4270 Example:
4271
4272 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4273 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004274 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4275 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004276
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004277 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4278 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4279 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4280 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4281 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4282 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4283 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4284 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4285
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004286 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4287 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4288 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4289 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4290 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4291 another equipment.
4292
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004293 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4294 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4295 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4296 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4297 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4298 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4299 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4300 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4301
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004302 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4303 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4304 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4305 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4306 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4307 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4308 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4309 admin privileges.
4310
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004311 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4312 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4313 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4314 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4315 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4316 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4317 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4318 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4319
4320 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4321 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4322 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4323 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4324 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4325 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4326
4327 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4328 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4329 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4330 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4331 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4332 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4333
4334 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4335 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4336 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4337 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4338 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4339 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4340 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4341 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4342 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4343
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004344 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4345 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4346 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4347 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4348 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4349 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4350 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4351 response header" for more information.
4352
4353 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4354 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4355 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4356 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4357 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004358 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4359 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004360
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004361 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4362 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4363 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4364 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4365 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4366 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4367
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004368 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4369 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4370 inline.
4371
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004372 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4373 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004374 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004377 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004379 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004380 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4381 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004382 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004383 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4384 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004385
4386 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4387 followed by some converters.
4388
4389 Example:
4390
4391 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4392
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004393 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4394 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4395
4396 Example:
4397
4398 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4399
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004400 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4401 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4402 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4403 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4404 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4405 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4406 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4407
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004408 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4409 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4410 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4411 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4412 continues.
4413
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004414 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4415 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4416 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4417 the actions evaluation continues.
4418
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004419 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4420 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4421 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4422 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4423 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4424 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4425 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4426 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4427 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4428 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4429 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4430 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4431 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4432 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4433 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4434 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4435
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004436 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4437
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004438 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004439 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4440 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004441 rules.
4442
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004443 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4444 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4445 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4446 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4447
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004448 Example:
4449 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4450
4451 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4452
4453 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4454 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4455
4456 Example:
4457 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4458
4459 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4460
4461 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4462 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4463
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004464 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4465 ACL usage.
4466
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004467
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004468http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4469 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4470
4471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 yes | no | yes | yes
4473
4474 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4475 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4476 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4477 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4478 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4479 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4480
4481 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4482
4483 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4484 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4485 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4486 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4487 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4488 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4489 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4490 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4491 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4492 not checking any request past the first one.
4493
4494 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4495 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4496 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4497 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4498 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4499 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4500 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4501
4502 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4503 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4504 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4505 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4506 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4507 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4508 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4509 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4510 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4511 downsides of rare connection failures.
4512
4513 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4514 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4515 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4516 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4517 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4518 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4519 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4520 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4521 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4522 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4523 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4524 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4525
4526 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4527 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4528 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4529 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4530
4531 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4532 and are never shared ;
4533
4534 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4535 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4536 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4537 and are never shared ;
4538
4539 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4540 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4541 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4542
4543 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4544 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4545 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4546
4547 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4548
4549
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004550http-send-name-header [<header>]
4551 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4552
4553 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | no | yes | yes
4555
4556 Arguments :
4557
4558 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4559
4560 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4561 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4562 is added with the header string proved.
4563
4564 See also : "server"
4565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004566id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004567 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 no | yes | yes | yes
4570 Arguments : none
4571
4572 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4573 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4574 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004575
4576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004577ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4578 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581
4582 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4583 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4584 and running).
4585
4586 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4587 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4588 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004589 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004590 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004592 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4593 "unless" condition is met.
4594
4595 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4596
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004597load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4598 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | no | yes | yes
4601
4602 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4603 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4604 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4605 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4606 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4607 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4608 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4609 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4610
4611 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4612 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004613 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004614
4615 Arguments:
4616 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4617 named "server-state-file".
4618
4619 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4620 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4621 name is used as a file name.
4622
4623 none don't load any stat for this backend
4624
4625 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004626 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4627 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4628 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4629 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4630 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004631
4632 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4633 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4634
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004635 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004636
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004637 global
4638 stats socket /tmp/socket
4639 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004640
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004641 defaults
4642 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004643
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004644 backend bk
4645 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4646 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004647
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004648
4649 Then one can run :
4650
4651 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4652
4653 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4654
4655 1
4656 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4657 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4658 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4659
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004660 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004661
4662 global
4663 stats socket /tmp/socket
4664 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4665
4666 defaults
4667 load-server-state-from-file local
4668
4669 backend bk
4670 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4671 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4672
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004673
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004674 Then one can run :
4675
4676 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4677
4678 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4679
4680 1
4681 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4682 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4683 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4684
4685 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4686 "show servers state"
4687
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004689log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004690log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004691no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004695
4696 Prefix :
4697 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4698 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4699 prefix does not allow arguments.
4700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701 Arguments :
4702 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4703 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4704 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4705 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4706 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4707 parameter.
4708
4709 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4710 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4711
4712 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4713 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4714 standard syslog port).
4715
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004716 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4717 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4718 standard syslog port).
4719
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004720 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4721 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4722 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4723 appropriately writeable).
4724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004725 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4726 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004727
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004728 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4729 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4730 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4731 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4732 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4733 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4734 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4735 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4736 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4737 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4738 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004740 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4741
4742 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4743 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4744 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4745
4746 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4747 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4748 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004749 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4750 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4751 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4752 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4753 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754
4755 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4756
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004757 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4758 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4759 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004760
4761 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4762 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4763 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4764 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4765
4766 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4767 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768
4769 Example :
4770 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004771 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4772 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004773 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004774
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004776log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004777 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004780
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004781 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4782 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4783 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4784 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4785 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004786
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004787log-format-sd <string>
4788 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | yes | yes | no
4791
4792 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4793 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4794 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4795 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4796 which covers the log format string in depth.
4797
4798 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4799 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4800
4801 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4802 log format to "rfc5424".
4803
4804 Example :
4805 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4806
4807
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004808log-tag <string>
4809 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812
4813 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4814 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4815 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4816 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4817 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4818 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4819 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4820 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4821 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004822
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004823max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4824 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | no | yes | yes
4827
4828 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4829 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4830 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4831 servers.
4832
4833 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4834 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4835 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4836 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4837 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4838 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4839 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4840 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4841 picking a different server.
4842
4843 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4844 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4845 even if they have to be queued.
4846
4847 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4848 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4849
4850
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004851maxconn <conns>
4852 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | yes | yes | no
4855 Arguments :
4856 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4857 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4858 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4859 closes.
4860
4861 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4862 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4863 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4864 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004865 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4866 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4867 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4868 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004869
4870 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4871 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4872 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4873
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004874 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004876 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4877
4878
4879mode { tcp|http|health }
4880 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | yes | yes | yes
4883 Arguments :
4884 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4885 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4886 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4887 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4888
4889 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4890 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4891 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4892 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4893 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4894
4895 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004896 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4897 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4898 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4899 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4900 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4901 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4902 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004904 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4905 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4906 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004907
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004908 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004909 defaults http_instances
4910 mode http
4911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004912 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004915monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4918 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004919 Arguments :
4920 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4921 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004922 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004923 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4924 backend and its backup.
4925
4926 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4927 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4928 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4929 servers in a list of backends.
4930
4931 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4932 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4933 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4934 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4935 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4936 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4937 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004938 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4939 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004940
4941 Example:
4942 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004944 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4945 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4946 monitor-uri /site_alive
4947 monitor fail if site_dead
4948
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004949 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004950
4951
4952monitor-net <source>
4953 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | yes | yes | no
4956 Arguments :
4957 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4958 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4959 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4960 followed by a mask.
4961
4962 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4963 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004964 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4966
4967 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4968 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4969 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4970 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004971 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4972 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4973 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004974
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004975 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4976 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4977 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4978 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4979 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4980 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004981
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004982 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4983 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004985 Example :
4986 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4987 frontend www
4988 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4989
4990 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4991
4992
4993monitor-uri <uri>
4994 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 yes | yes | yes | no
4997 Arguments :
4998 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4999 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5000
5001 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5002 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5003 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5004 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5005 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5006 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5007 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5008 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5009
5010 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5011 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5012 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5013 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5014 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5015 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5016
5017 Example :
5018 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5019 frontend www
5020 mode http
5021 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5022
5023 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005025
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005026option abortonclose
5027no option abortonclose
5028 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | no | yes | yes
5031 Arguments : none
5032
5033 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5034 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5035 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5036 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005037 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005038 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5039 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5040 encountered while delivering the response.
5041
5042 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5043 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5044 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5045 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5046 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5047 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005048 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005049 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005050 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005051 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5052 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5053 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5054
5055 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5056 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5057 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5058 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5059 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5060 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5061 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5062 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005063 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005064
5065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5067
5068 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5069
5070
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005071option accept-invalid-http-request
5072no option accept-invalid-http-request
5073 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | yes | yes | no
5076 Arguments : none
5077
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005078 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005079 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5080 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5081 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5082 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5083 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5084 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5085 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005086 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5087 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5088 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5089 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5090 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005091 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005092 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5093 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5094 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005095
5096 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5097 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5098 been confirmed.
5099
5100 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5101 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005102 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5103 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005104 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5105
5106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5108
5109 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5110 stats socket.
5111
5112
5113option accept-invalid-http-response
5114no option accept-invalid-http-response
5115 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 yes | no | yes | yes
5118 Arguments : none
5119
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005120 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005121 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5122 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5123 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5124 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5125 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5126 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5127 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005128 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5129 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5130 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005131
5132 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5133 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5134 been confirmed.
5135
5136 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5137 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5138 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5139 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5140
5141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5143
5144 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5145 stats socket.
5146
5147
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005148option allbackups
5149no option allbackups
5150 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | no | yes | yes
5153 Arguments : none
5154
5155 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5156 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5157 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5158 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5159 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5160 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5161 order between the backup servers anymore.
5162
5163 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5164 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5165
5166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5168
5169
5170option checkcache
5171no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005172 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | no | yes | yes
5175 Arguments : none
5176
5177 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5178 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005179 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005180 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5181 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005182 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005183
5184 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005185 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005186 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005187 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5188 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005189 to the client are :
5190 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005191 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005192 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005193 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5194 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5195 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5196 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5197 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5198 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5199 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5200 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5202 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5203 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5204
5205 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005206 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005207 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005208 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005209 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5210
5211 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5212 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005213 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005214 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5215
5216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5218
5219
5220option clitcpka
5221no option clitcpka
5222 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | yes | yes | no
5225 Arguments : none
5226
5227 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5228 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5229 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5230 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5231
5232 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5233 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5234 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5235 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5236
5237 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5238 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5239 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5240 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5241 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5242
5243 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5244
5245 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5246 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5247 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5248
5249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5251
5252 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5253
5254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005255option contstats
5256 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | yes | yes | no
5259 Arguments : none
5260
5261 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5262 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5263 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5264 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005265 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5266 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5267 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5268 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5269 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005270
5271
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005272option dontlog-normal
5273no option dontlog-normal
5274 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 yes | yes | yes | no
5277 Arguments : none
5278
5279 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5280 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5281 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5282 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5283 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5284 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5285 logged.
5286
5287 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5288 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5289 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005291 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005292 logging.
5293
5294
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005295option dontlognull
5296no option dontlognull
5297 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | yes | yes | no
5300 Arguments : none
5301
5302 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5303 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5304 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5305 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5306 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5307 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005308 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5309 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5310 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005311
5312 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5313 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5314 would not be logged.
5315
5316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5318
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005319 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5320 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005321
5322
5323option forceclose
5324no option forceclose
5325 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005328 Arguments : none
5329
5330 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5331 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5332 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5333 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5334 global session times in the logs.
5335
5336 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005337 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005338 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005339
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005340 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5341 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5342 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5343
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005344 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5345 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005346
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5349
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005350 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005351
5352
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005353option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005354 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | yes | yes | yes
5357 Arguments :
5358 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5359 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005360 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005361 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005362
5363 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5364 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5365 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5366 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5367 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5368 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5369 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005370 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5371 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5372 possible that the client has already brought one.
5373
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005374 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005375 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005376 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5377 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005378 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5379 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005380
5381 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5382 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5383 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5384 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5385 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5386 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5387 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5388
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005389 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5390 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5391 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5392 are under the control of the end-user.
5393
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005394 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005395 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5396 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005397 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5398 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5399 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005400
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005401 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005402 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5403 frontend www
5404 mode http
5405 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5406
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005407 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5408 backend www
5409 mode http
5410 option forwardfor header X-Client
5411
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005412 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005413 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005414
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005415
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005416option http-buffer-request
5417no option http-buffer-request
5418 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | yes | yes | yes
5421 Arguments : none
5422
5423 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5424 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5425 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5426 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5427 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5428 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5429 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5430 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005431 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005432 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5433 default.
5434
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005435 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005436
5437
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005438option http-ignore-probes
5439no option http-ignore-probes
5440 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | yes | yes | no
5443 Arguments : none
5444
5445 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5446 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5447 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5448 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5449 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5450 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5451 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5452 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5453 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5454 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5455 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5456 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5457
5458 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5459 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5460 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5461 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5462 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5463 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5464 are often the only way to detect them.
5465
5466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5468
5469 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5470
5471
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005472option http-keep-alive
5473no option http-keep-alive
5474 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 yes | yes | yes | yes
5477 Arguments : none
5478
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005479 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5480 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5481 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5482 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5483 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5484 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5485 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5486
5487 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5488 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005489 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5490 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5491 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5492 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5493 situations where this option may be useful :
5494
5495 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5496 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5497
5498 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5499 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5500
5501 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5502 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5503 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5504 request.
5505
5506 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5507 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005508 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5509 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5510 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005511
5512 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5513 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5514
5515 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5516 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5517 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5518 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5519 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5520 not set.
5521
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005522 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5523 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005524 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005525 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005526
5527 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005528 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5529 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005530
5531
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005532option http-no-delay
5533no option http-no-delay
5534 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5536 yes | yes | yes | yes
5537 Arguments : none
5538
5539 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5540 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5541 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5542 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5543 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5544 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5545 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5546 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5547 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5548 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5549 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5550 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5551 affected.
5552
5553 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5554 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5555 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5556 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5557 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5558 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5559 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5560 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5561 latency environments.
5562
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005563 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5564
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005565
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005566option http-pretend-keepalive
5567no option http-pretend-keepalive
5568 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5570 yes | yes | yes | yes
5571 Arguments : none
5572
5573 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5574 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5575 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5576 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5577 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5578 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5579 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5580 consider the response complete.
5581
5582 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5583 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5584 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5585 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5586 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5587 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5588
5589 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5590 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5591 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5592 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5593 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5594 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5595 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5596
5597 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5598 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005599 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005600 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5601 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005602
5603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5605
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005606 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5607 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005608
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005609
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005610option http-server-close
5611no option http-server-close
5612 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5614 yes | yes | yes | yes
5615 Arguments : none
5616
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005617 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5618 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5619 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5620 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5621 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5622 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5623 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5624 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5625 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5626 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5627 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5628 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5629 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5630 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5631 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5632 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005633
5634 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5635 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5636 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5637 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005638 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5639 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005640
5641 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5642 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005643 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5644 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005645 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5646 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005647
5648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5650
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005651 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005652 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5653 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005654
5655
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005656option http-tunnel
5657no option http-tunnel
5658 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 yes | yes | yes | yes
5661 Arguments : none
5662
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005663 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5664 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5665 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5666 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5667 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5668 "option http-tunnel".
5669
5670 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005671 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005672 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5673 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5674 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5675 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5676 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5677 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5678 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005679
5680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5682
5683 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5684 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5685 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5686
5687
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005688option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005689no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005690 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5692 yes | yes | yes | no
5693 Arguments : none
5694
5695 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5696 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5697 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5698 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5699 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5700 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5701 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5702
5703 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5704 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005705 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5706 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5707 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005708
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005709 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5710 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5711 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5712 front of an existing proxy.
5713
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005714 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5715
5716 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5717 http-server-close".
5718
5719
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005720option httpchk
5721option httpchk <uri>
5722option httpchk <method> <uri>
5723option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5724 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | yes | yes
5727 Arguments :
5728 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5729 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5730 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5731 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5732 ones.
5733
5734 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5735 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5736 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5737
5738 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5739 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5740 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5741 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5742 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5743
5744 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5745 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5746 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5747 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5748 the lack of any response.
5749
5750 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5751
5752 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5753 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5754 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5755
5756 Examples :
5757 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5758 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5759 backend https_relay
5760 mode tcp
5761 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5762 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5763
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005764 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5765 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5766 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005767
5768
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005769option httpclose
5770no option httpclose
5771 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5773 yes | yes | yes | yes
5774 Arguments : none
5775
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005776 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5777 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5778 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5779 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005780 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005781 "option http-tunnel".
5782
5783 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5784 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5785 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5786 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5787 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5788 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5789 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5790 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005791
5792 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005793 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005794 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5795 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5796 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5797 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5798 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005799
5800 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5801 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005802 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5803 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005804 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5805 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005806
5807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5809
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005810 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5811 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005812
5813
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005814option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005815 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005818 Arguments :
5819 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5820 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5821 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5822 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5823 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005824
5825 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5826 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5827 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5828 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5829 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5830 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5831 ports.
5832
5833 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5834
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005835 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5836 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005838 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005840
5841option http_proxy
5842no option http_proxy
5843 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | yes | yes | yes
5846 Arguments : none
5847
5848 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5849 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5850 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5851 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5852 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5853
5854 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5855 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005856 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5857 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005858
5859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5861
5862 Example :
5863 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5864 backend direct_forward
5865 option httpclose
5866 option http_proxy
5867
5868 See also : "option httpclose"
5869
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005870
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005871option independent-streams
5872no option independent-streams
5873 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 yes | yes | yes | yes
5876 Arguments : none
5877
5878 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5879 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5880 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5881 receive data or not.
5882
5883 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5884 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5885 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5886 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5887 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5888 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5889 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5890 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5891 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5892 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5893 socket buffers.
5894
5895 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5896 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5897 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5898 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5899 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5900
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005901 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005902 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5903 deprecated.
5904
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005905 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005906
5907
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005908option ldap-check
5909 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 yes | no | yes | yes
5912 Arguments : none
5913
5914 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5915 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5916 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5917 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5918
5919 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5920 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5921
5922 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5923 configure it.
5924
5925 Example :
5926 option ldap-check
5927
5928 See also : "option httpchk"
5929
5930
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005931option external-check
5932 Use external processes for server health checks
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | no | yes | yes
5935
5936 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5937 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5938 command".
5939
5940 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5941
5942 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5943
5944
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005945option log-health-checks
5946no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005947 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5949 yes | no | yes | yes
5950 Arguments : none
5951
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005952 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5953 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5954 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005955
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005956 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5957 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5958 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5959 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5960 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5961
5962 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5963 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005964
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005965 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5966 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5967 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005968
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005969
5970option log-separate-errors
5971no option log-separate-errors
5972 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | yes | yes | no
5975 Arguments : none
5976
5977 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5978 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5979 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5980 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5981 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5982 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5983 provides very important information.
5984
5985 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5986 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5987 error logs.
5988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005989 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005990 logging.
5991
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005992
5993option logasap
5994no option logasap
5995 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | yes | yes | no
5998 Arguments : none
5999
6000 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6001 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6002 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6003 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6004 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6005 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6006 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006007 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006008 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6009 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6010
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006011 Examples :
6012 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6013 mode http
6014 option httplog
6015 option logasap
6016 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6017
6018 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6019 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6020 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6021 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006023 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006024 logging.
6025
6026
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006027option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006028 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6030 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006031 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006032 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6033 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006034 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006035
6036 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6037 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6038 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6039 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6040 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6041 in the MySQL table, like this :
6042
6043 USE mysql;
6044 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6045 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6046
6047 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6048 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6049 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6050 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6051 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6052 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6053 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6054 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6055 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6056
6057 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6058 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006059
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006060 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006061
6062 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6063 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6064 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6065 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006066 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6067 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006068
6069 See also: "option httpchk"
6070
6071
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006072option nolinger
6073no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006074 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006077 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006078
6079 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6080 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6081 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6082 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6083 connections.
6084
6085 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6086 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6087 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6088 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6089 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6090 this too.
6091
6092 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6093 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6094 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6095
6096 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6097 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6098 for servers.
6099
6100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6102
6103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006104option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6105 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6107 yes | yes | yes | yes
6108 Arguments :
6109 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6110 matching <network>
6111 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6112 header name.
6113
6114 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6115 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6116 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6117 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6118 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6119 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6120 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6121 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6122 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6123 possible that the client has already brought one.
6124
6125 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6126 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6127 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6128 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6129 header and requires different one.
6130
6131 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6132 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6133 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6134 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6135 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6136 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6137 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6138
6139 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6140 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6141 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6142 both are defined.
6143
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006144 Examples :
6145 # Original Destination address
6146 frontend www
6147 mode http
6148 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6149
6150 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6151 backend www
6152 mode http
6153 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6154
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006155 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6156 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006157
6158
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006159option persist
6160no option persist
6161 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006164 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006165
6166 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6167 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6168 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6169 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6170 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6171 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6172 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6173 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6174 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6175 redirected to another valid server.
6176
6177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6179
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006180 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006181
6182
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006183option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6184 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
6187 Arguments :
6188 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6189 PostgreSQL server.
6190
6191 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6192 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6193 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6194 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6195
6196 See also: "option httpchk"
6197
6198
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006199option prefer-last-server
6200no option prefer-last-server
6201 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 yes | no | yes | yes
6204 Arguments : none
6205
6206 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6207 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6208 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6209 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6210 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6211 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6212 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6213 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6214 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006215 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6216 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6217 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6218 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6219 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6220 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6221 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006222
6223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6225
6226 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6227
6228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006229option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006230option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006231no option redispatch
6232 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006235 Arguments :
6236 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6237 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6238 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6239 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6240 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6241 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6242 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6243 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6244 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006246
6247 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6248 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6249 be able to access the service anymore.
6250
6251 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6252 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6253
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006254 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006255 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6256 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006258 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6259 "redisp" keywords.
6260
6261 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6262 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6263
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006264 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006265
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006266
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006267option redis-check
6268 Use redis health checks for server testing
6269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 yes | no | yes | yes
6271 Arguments : none
6272
6273 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6274 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6275 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6276 find the "+PONG" response message.
6277
6278 Example :
6279 option redis-check
6280
6281 See also : "option httpchk"
6282
6283
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006284option smtpchk
6285option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6286 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006290 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6291 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6292 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6293
6294 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6295 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6296 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6297
6298 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6299 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6300 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6301 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6302 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6303 dead server.
6304
6305 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6306 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6307 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6308 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6309
6310 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6311 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6312 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6313 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006314 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006315
6316 Example :
6317 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6318
6319 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006322option socket-stats
6323no option socket-stats
6324
6325 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6327 yes | yes | yes | no
6328
6329 Arguments : none
6330
6331
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006332option splice-auto
6333no option splice-auto
6334 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | yes | yes | yes
6337 Arguments : none
6338
6339 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6340 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6341 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6342 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006343 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006344 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6345 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6346 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6347 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6348
6349 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6350 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6351 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6352 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6353 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6354 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6355 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6356 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6357 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6358 keyword.
6359
6360 Example :
6361 option splice-auto
6362
6363 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6364 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6365
6366 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6367 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6368
6369
6370option splice-request
6371no option splice-request
6372 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6374 yes | yes | yes | yes
6375 Arguments : none
6376
6377 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006378 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006379 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6380 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6381 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6382 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6383
6384 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6385
6386 Example :
6387 option splice-request
6388
6389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6391
6392 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6393 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6394
6395
6396option splice-response
6397no option splice-response
6398 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | yes | yes | yes
6401 Arguments : none
6402
6403 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006404 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006405 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6406 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6407 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6408 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6409
6410 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6411
6412 Example :
6413 option splice-response
6414
6415 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6416 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6417
6418 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6419 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6420
6421
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006422option spop-check
6423 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 no | no | no | yes
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6429 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6430 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6431 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6432
6433 Example :
6434 option spop-check
6435
6436 See also : "option httpchk"
6437
6438
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006439option srvtcpka
6440no option srvtcpka
6441 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6443 yes | no | yes | yes
6444 Arguments : none
6445
6446 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6447 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6448 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6449 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6450
6451 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6452 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6453 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6454 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6455
6456 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6457 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6458 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6459 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6460 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6461
6462 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6463
6464 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6465 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6466 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6467
6468 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6469 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6470
6471 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6472
6473
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006474option ssl-hello-chk
6475 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | no | yes | yes
6478 Arguments : none
6479
6480 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6481 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6482 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6483 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6484 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6485 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6486 hello message.
6487
6488 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6489 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6490 messages, which is appreciable.
6491
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006492 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6493 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6494 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006495
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006496 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6497
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006498
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006499option tcp-check
6500 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | no | yes | yes
6503
6504 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6505 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6506
6507 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6508 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6509 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6510
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006511 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006512 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6513 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6514 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6515 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6516 only.
6517
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006518 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006519 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6520 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6521 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6522 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6523
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006524 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006525 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6526 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006527 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006528 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6529 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6530 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6531 the respective protocols.
6532 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6533 analysed.
6534
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006535 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6536 script.
6537
6538 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6539 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6540 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6541 The "comment" is of course optional.
6542
6543
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006544 Examples :
6545 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6546 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006547 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006548
6549 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6550 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006551 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006552
6553 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6554 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006555 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006556 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006557 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006558 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006559 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006560 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006561 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6562 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006563 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006564 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6565 tcp-check expect string +OK
6566
6567 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6568 (send many headers before analyzing)
6569 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006570 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006571 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6572 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6573 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6574 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006575 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006576
6577
6578 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6579
6580
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006581option tcp-smart-accept
6582no option tcp-smart-accept
6583 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6585 yes | yes | yes | no
6586 Arguments : none
6587
6588 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6589 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6590 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6591 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6592 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6593 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6594
6595 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6596 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6597 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6598 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6599
6600 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6601 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6602 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6603 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6604
6605 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6606 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6607 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6608
6609 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6610 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6611 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6612
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006613 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6614
6615
6616option tcp-smart-connect
6617no option tcp-smart-connect
6618 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | no | yes | yes
6621 Arguments : none
6622
6623 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6624 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6625 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6626 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6627 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6628
6629 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6630 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6631 complex.
6632
6633 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6634 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6635 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6636
6637 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6638 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6639
6640 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6641
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006642
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006643option tcpka
6644 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6646 yes | yes | yes | yes
6647 Arguments : none
6648
6649 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6650 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6651 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6652 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6653
6654 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6655 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6656 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6657 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6658
6659 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6660 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6661 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6662 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6663 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6664
6665 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6666
6667 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6668 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6669 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6670 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6671 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6672 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6673 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6674 backends.
6675
6676 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6677
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006678
6679option tcplog
6680 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6682 yes | yes | yes | yes
6683 Arguments : none
6684
6685 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6686 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6687 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6688 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6689 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6690 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6691 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6692 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6693
6694 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006696 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006697
6698
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006699option transparent
6700no option transparent
6701 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006703 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006704 Arguments : none
6705
6706 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6707 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6708 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6709 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6710 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6711 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6712 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6713 appropriate server.
6714
6715 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6716 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6717
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006718 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006719 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006720
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006721
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006722external-check command <command>
6723 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | no | yes | yes
6726
6727 Arguments :
6728 <command> is the external command to run
6729
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006730 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6731
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006732 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006733
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006734 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6735 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6736 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6737 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6738 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6739 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006740
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006741 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6742
6743 Environment variables :
6744 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6745 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6746
6747 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6748
6749 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6750
6751 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6752 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6753 for a UNIX socket).
6754
6755 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6756
6757 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6758
6759 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6760
6761 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6762
6763 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6764
6765 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6766 socket).
6767
6768 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6769 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6770
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006771 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6772 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6773 failed.
6774
6775 Example :
6776 external-check command /bin/true
6777
6778 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6779
6780
6781external-check path <path>
6782 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6784 yes | no | yes | yes
6785
6786 Arguments :
6787 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6788
6789 The default path is "".
6790
6791 Example :
6792 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6793
6794 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6795 "external-check command"
6796
6797
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006798persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006799persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006800 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6802 yes | no | yes | yes
6803 Arguments :
6804 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006805 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6806 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006807
6808 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6809 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6810 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6811 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6812 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6813 forwarded to this server.
6814
6815 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6816 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6817 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006818 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006819 a single "listen" section.
6820
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006821 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6822 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6823 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6824
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006825 Example :
6826 listen tse-farm
6827 bind :3389
6828 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6829 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6830 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6831 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6832 persist rdp-cookie
6833 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006834 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006835 balance rdp-cookie
6836 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6837 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6838
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006839 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6840 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006841
6842
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006843rate-limit sessions <rate>
6844 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | yes | yes | no
6847 Arguments :
6848 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6849 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6850
6851 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6852 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6853 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6854 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6855 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6856 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6857
6858 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6859 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6860 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6861 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6862
6863 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6864 listen smtp
6865 mode tcp
6866 bind :25
6867 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006868 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006869
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006870 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6871 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6872 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006873
6874 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6875
6876
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006877redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6878redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6879redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006880 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 no | yes | yes | yes
6883
6884 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006885 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006886
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006887 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006888 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006889 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6890 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6891 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006892
6893 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6894 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6895 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6896 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6897 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006898 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6899 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6900 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6901 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006902
6903 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6904 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6905 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6906 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6907 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6908 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006909 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006910 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006911 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6912 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6913 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006914
6915 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006916 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6917 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6918 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006919 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006920 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6921 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6922 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6923 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006924
6925 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6926 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6927
6928 - "drop-query"
6929 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6930 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6931 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6932 with a location-type redirect.
6933
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006934 - "append-slash"
6935 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6936 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6937 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6938 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6939
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006940 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6941 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6942 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6943 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6944 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6945 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6946 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6947
6948 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6949 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6950 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6951 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6952 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6953 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6954 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006955
6956 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6957 acl clear dst_port 80
6958 acl secure dst_port 8080
6959 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006960 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006961 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006962 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6963
6964 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006965 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6966 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6967 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006968 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006969
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006970 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6971 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6972 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6973
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006974 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006975 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006976
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006977 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006978 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6979 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6980 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006982 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006983
6984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006985redisp (deprecated)
6986redispatch (deprecated)
6987 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006990 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006991
6992 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6993 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6994 be able to access the service anymore.
6995
6996 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6997 redistribute them to a working server.
6998
6999 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7000 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7001 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007003 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7004 "option redispatch" instead.
7005
7006 See also : "option redispatch"
7007
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007008
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007009reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007010 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 no | yes | yes | yes
7013 Arguments :
7014 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7015 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007016 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007017
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007018 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7019 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7020
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007021 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7022 the last header of an HTTP request.
7023
7024 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7025 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7026 responses.
7027
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007028 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7029 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7030 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7031
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007032 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7033 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007034
7035
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007036reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7037reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007038 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7040 no | yes | yes | yes
7041 Arguments :
7042 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7043 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7044 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7045 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7046 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7047 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7048 ignores case.
7049
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007050 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7051 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7052
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007053 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7054 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7055 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7056 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007057 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007058
7059 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7060 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7061
7062 Example :
7063 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7064 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7065 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7066
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007067 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7068 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007069
7070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007071reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7072reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 no | yes | yes | yes
7076 Arguments :
7077 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7078 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7079 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7080 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7081 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7082 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7083
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007084 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7085 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7086
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007087 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7088 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7089 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7090 next servers.
7091
7092 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7093 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7094 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7095
7096 Example :
7097 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7098 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7099 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7100
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007101 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7102 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007103
7104
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007105reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7106reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | yes | yes | yes
7110 Arguments :
7111 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7112 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7113 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7114 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7115 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7116 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7117 case.
7118
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007119 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7120 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7121
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007122 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7123 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7124 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7125 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007126 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007127
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007128 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007129 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007130 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007131
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007132 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7133 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7134
7135 Example :
7136 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7137 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7138 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7139
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007140 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7141 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007142
7143
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007144reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7145reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007146 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 no | yes | yes | yes
7149 Arguments :
7150 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7151 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7152 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7153 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7154 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7155 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7156 case.
7157
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007158 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7159 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7160
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007161 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7162 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7163 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7164 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7165
7166 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7167 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7168
7169 Example :
7170 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7171 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7172 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7173 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7174
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007175 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7176 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007177
7178
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007179reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7180reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007181 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7183 no | yes | yes | yes
7184 Arguments :
7185 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7186 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7187 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7188 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7189 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7190 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7191
7192 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7193 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7194 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7195 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007196 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007198 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7199 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007201 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7202 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7203 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7204
7205 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7206 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7207 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7208 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7209 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7210
7211 Example :
7212 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007213 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007214 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7215 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7216
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007217 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7218 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007219
7220
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007221reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7222reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007223 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7225 no | yes | yes | yes
7226 Arguments :
7227 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7228 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7229 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7230 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7231 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7232 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7233 ignores case.
7234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007235 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7236 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7237
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007238 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7239 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007240 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7241 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7242 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007243 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7244 not set.
7245
7246 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7247 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7248 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7249 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7250 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7251
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007252 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007253 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7254 # block all others.
7255 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7256 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7257
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007258 # block bad guys
7259 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7260 reqitarpit . if badguys
7261
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007262 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7263 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007264
7265
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007266retries <value>
7267 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 yes | no | yes | yes
7270 Arguments :
7271 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7272 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7273 default value is 3.
7274
7275 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7276 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7277 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7278
7279 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007280 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7281 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007282
7283 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7284 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7285
7286 See also : "option redispatch"
7287
7288
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007289rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7292 no | yes | yes | yes
7293 Arguments :
7294 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7295 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007296 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007297
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007298 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7299 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7300
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007301 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7302 the last header of an HTTP response.
7303
7304 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7305 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7306 responses.
7307
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007308 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7309 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007310
7311
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007312rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7313rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007314 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7316 no | yes | yes | yes
7317 Arguments :
7318 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7319 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7320 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7321 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7322 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7323 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7324 ignores case.
7325
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007326 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7327 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7328
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007329 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7330 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007331 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007332 client.
7333
7334 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7335 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7336 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7337
7338 Example :
7339 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007340 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007341
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007342 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7343 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007344
7345
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007346rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7347rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 no | yes | yes | yes
7351 Arguments :
7352 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7353 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7354 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7355 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7356 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7357 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7358 ignores case.
7359
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007360 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7361 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7362
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007363 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7364 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7365 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7366 case-sensitive.
7367
7368 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007369 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7370 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7371 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007372
7373 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7374 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7375
7376 Example :
7377 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7378 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7379
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007380 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7381 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007382
7383
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007384rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7385rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007386 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 no | yes | yes | yes
7389 Arguments :
7390 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7391 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7392 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7393 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7394 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7395 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7396 ignores case.
7397
7398 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7399 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7400 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7401 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007402 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007403
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007404 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7405 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7406
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007407 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7408 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7409 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7410
7411 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7412 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7413 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7414 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7415 are not case-sensitive.
7416
7417 Example :
7418 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7419 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7420
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007421 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7422 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007423
7424
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007425server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007426 Declare a server in a backend
7427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 no | no | yes | yes
7429 Arguments :
7430 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007431 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007432 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007433
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007434 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7435 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7436 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7437 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007438 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7439 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7440 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7441 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7442 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007443 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7444 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7445 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7446 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7447 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7448 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7449 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007450 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007451 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7452 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007453 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7454 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007455
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007456 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007457 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7458 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7459 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7460 adding this value to the client's port.
7461
7462 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7463 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007464 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007465
7466 Examples :
7467 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7468 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007469 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007470 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7471 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7472 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007473
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007474 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7475 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7476 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7477 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7478 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7479
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007480 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7481 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007482
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007483server-state-file-name [<file>]
7484 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7485 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7486 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7487 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7488 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7489 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7490
7491 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7492 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7493
7494 global
7495 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7496
7497 backend bk
7498 load-server-state-from-file
7499
7500 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7501 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007502
7503source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007504source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007505source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007506 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | no | yes | yes
7509 Arguments :
7510 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7511 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007512
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007513 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007514 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7515 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7516 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7517 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7518 supported prefixes are :
7519 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7520 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7521 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007522 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007523 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7524 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007525
7526 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7527 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007528 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7529 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7530 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007531
7532 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7533 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7534 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7535 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7536 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7537 <addr>.
7538
7539 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7540 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7541 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7542 port.
7543
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007544 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7545 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7546 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7547 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007548 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007549 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7550 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7551 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7552 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7553 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7554 HTTP header.
7555
7556 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7557 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007558 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007559 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7560 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7561 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7562 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7563 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7564 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7565 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7566
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007567 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7568 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7569 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7570 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7571 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7572 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7573
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007574 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7575 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7576 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7577 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7578
7579 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7580 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7581 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7582 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7583 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7584 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7585
7586 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7587 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7588 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7589 there are two methods :
7590
7591 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7592 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7593 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7594 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7595 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7596 of the client ranges may be used.
7597
7598 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7599 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7600 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7601 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7602 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7603 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7604 same session.
7605
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007606 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7607 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7608 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007609 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007610
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007611 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7612
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007613 Examples :
7614 backend private
7615 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7616 source 192.168.1.200
7617
7618 backend transparent_ssl1
7619 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7620 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7621
7622 backend transparent_ssl2
7623 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7624 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7625 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7626
7627 backend transparent_ssl3
7628 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7629 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7630 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7631
7632 backend transparent_smtp
7633 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7634 # with Tproxy version 4.
7635 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7636
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007637 backend transparent_http
7638 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7639 # proxy.
7640 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007642 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007643 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007645
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007646srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7647 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7649 yes | no | yes | yes
7650 Arguments :
7651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7653 as explained at the top of this document.
7654
7655 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7656 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7657 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7658 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7659 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7660 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7661 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7662
7663 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7664 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7665 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7666 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7667 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007668 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007669 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007670 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007671
7672 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7673 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7674 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7675 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7676 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7677 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7678
7679 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7680 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7681
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007682 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7683 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007684
7685
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007686stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7687 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007689 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007690
7691 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7692 matched.
7693
7694 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7695 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7696
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007697 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7698 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7699 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7700
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007701 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7702 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7703 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7704 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007705
7706 Example :
7707 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7708 backend stats_localhost
7709 stats enable
7710 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7711
7712 Example :
7713 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7714 backend stats_auth
7715 stats enable
7716 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7717 stats admin if TRUE
7718
7719 Example :
7720 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7721 userlist stats-auth
7722 group admin users admin
7723 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7724 group readonly users haproxy
7725 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7726
7727 backend stats_auth
7728 stats enable
7729 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7730 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7731 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7732 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7733
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007734 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7735 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7736 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007737
7738
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007739stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7740 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007743 Arguments :
7744 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7745
7746 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7747
7748 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7749 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7750 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7751 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7752 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7753 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7754
7755 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7756 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7757 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007758 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007759
7760 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7761 report using "stats scope".
7762
7763 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7764 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7765 unobvious parameters.
7766
7767 Example :
7768 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7769 backend public_www
7770 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7771 stats enable
7772 stats hide-version
7773 stats scope .
7774 stats uri /admin?stats
7775 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7776 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7777 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7778
7779 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7780 backend private_monitoring
7781 stats enable
7782 stats uri /admin?stats
7783 stats refresh 5s
7784
7785 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7786
7787
7788stats enable
7789 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007791 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792 Arguments : none
7793
7794 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7795 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7796 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7797 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7798 - stats auth : no authentication
7799 - stats scope : no restriction
7800
7801 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7802 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7803 unobvious parameters.
7804
7805 Example :
7806 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7807 backend public_www
7808 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7809 stats enable
7810 stats hide-version
7811 stats scope .
7812 stats uri /admin?stats
7813 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7814 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7815 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7816
7817 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7818 backend private_monitoring
7819 stats enable
7820 stats uri /admin?stats
7821 stats refresh 5s
7822
7823 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7824
7825
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007826stats hide-version
7827 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007830 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007832 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7833 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7834 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7835 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7836 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7837 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7841 unobvious parameters.
7842
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007843 Example :
7844 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7845 backend public_www
7846 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007847 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007848 stats hide-version
7849 stats scope .
7850 stats uri /admin?stats
7851 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7852 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7853 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007854
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007855 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7856 backend private_monitoring
7857 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007858 stats uri /admin?stats
7859 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007860
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007861 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007862
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007863
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007864stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7866 Access control for statistics
7867
7868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7869 no | no | yes | yes
7870
7871 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7872 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7873 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7874 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7875 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7876 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7877
7878 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7879 instance.
7880
7881 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7882 about ACL usage.
7883
7884
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885stats realm <realm>
7886 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007889 Arguments :
7890 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7891 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7892 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7893
7894 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7895 using a backslash ('\').
7896
7897 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7898 only related to authentication.
7899
7900 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7901 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7902 unobvious parameters.
7903
7904 Example :
7905 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7906 backend public_www
7907 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7908 stats enable
7909 stats hide-version
7910 stats scope .
7911 stats uri /admin?stats
7912 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7913 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7914 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7915
7916 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7917 backend private_monitoring
7918 stats enable
7919 stats uri /admin?stats
7920 stats refresh 5s
7921
7922 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7923
7924
7925stats refresh <delay>
7926 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007928 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007929 Arguments :
7930 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7931 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7932 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7933 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7934 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7935 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7936
7937 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7938 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7939 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7940 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7941
7942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7944 unobvious parameters.
7945
7946 Example :
7947 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7948 backend public_www
7949 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7950 stats enable
7951 stats hide-version
7952 stats scope .
7953 stats uri /admin?stats
7954 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7955 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7956 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7957
7958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7959 backend private_monitoring
7960 stats enable
7961 stats uri /admin?stats
7962 stats refresh 5s
7963
7964 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7965
7966
7967stats scope { <name> | "." }
7968 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007970 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007971 Arguments :
7972 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7973 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7974 section in which the statement appears.
7975
7976 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7977 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7978 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7979 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7980 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7981 exists.
7982
7983 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7984 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7985 unobvious parameters.
7986
7987 Example :
7988 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7989 backend public_www
7990 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7991 stats enable
7992 stats hide-version
7993 stats scope .
7994 stats uri /admin?stats
7995 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7996 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7997 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7998
7999 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8000 backend private_monitoring
8001 stats enable
8002 stats uri /admin?stats
8003 stats refresh 5s
8004
8005 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008007
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008008stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008009 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008011 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008013 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008014 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8015
8016 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8017 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8018
8019 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8020 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008021 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008022
8023 Example :
8024 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8025 backend private_monitoring
8026 stats enable
8027 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8028 stats uri /admin?stats
8029 stats refresh 5s
8030
8031 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8032 global section.
8033
8034
8035stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008036 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 yes | yes | yes | yes
8039 Arguments : none
8040
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008041 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008042 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8043 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8044 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8045 - IP (socket, server)
8046 - cookie (backend, server)
8047
8048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008050 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008051
8052 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8053
8054
8055stats show-node [ <name> ]
8056 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008058 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008059 Arguments:
8060 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8061 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8062
8063 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8064 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008065 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008066
8067 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8068 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8069 unobvious parameters.
8070
8071 Example:
8072 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8073 backend private_monitoring
8074 stats enable
8075 stats show-node Europe-1
8076 stats uri /admin?stats
8077 stats refresh 5s
8078
8079 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8080 section.
8081
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082
8083stats uri <prefix>
8084 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008086 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087 Arguments :
8088 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8089 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8090 query string.
8091
8092 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8093 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8094 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8095 possible to reach it in the application.
8096
8097 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008098 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008099 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8100 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8101 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8102 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8103
8104 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8105 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8106 an address or a port to statistics only.
8107
8108 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8109 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8110 unobvious parameters.
8111
8112 Example :
8113 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8114 backend public_www
8115 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8116 stats enable
8117 stats hide-version
8118 stats scope .
8119 stats uri /admin?stats
8120 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8121 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8122 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8123
8124 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8125 backend private_monitoring
8126 stats enable
8127 stats uri /admin?stats
8128 stats refresh 5s
8129
8130 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8131
8132
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008133stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8134 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008136 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008137
8138 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008139 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008140 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8141 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8142 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8143
8144 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8145 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8146 the "stick-table" statement.
8147
8148 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8149 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8150 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8151 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8152 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8153
8154 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8155 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8156 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8157 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8158 transformation rules.
8159
8160 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8161 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8162 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8163 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8164 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8165 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8166 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8167
8168 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8169 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8170 ACL based conditions.
8171
8172 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8173 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8174 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8175 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8176
8177 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8178 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8179 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8180 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8181
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008182 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8183 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8184 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8185
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008186 Example :
8187 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8188 # last 30 minutes
8189 backend pop
8190 mode tcp
8191 balance roundrobin
8192 stick store-request src
8193 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8194 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8195 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8196
8197 backend smtp
8198 mode tcp
8199 balance roundrobin
8200 stick match src table pop
8201 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8202 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8203
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008204 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008205 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008206
8207
8208stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8209 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 no | no | yes | yes
8212
8213 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8214 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8215 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8216 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8217
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008218 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8219 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8220 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8221
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008222 Examples :
8223 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008224 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008225
8226 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8227 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8228 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8229
8230
8231 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8232 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8233 backend http
8234 mode http
8235 balance roundrobin
8236 stick on src table https
8237 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8238 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8239 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8240
8241 backend https
8242 mode tcp
8243 balance roundrobin
8244 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8245 stick on src
8246 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8247 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8248
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008249 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008250
8251
8252stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8253 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 no | no | yes | yes
8256
8257 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008258 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008259 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8260 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8261 server is selected.
8262
8263 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8264 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8265 the "stick-table" statement.
8266
8267 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8268 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8269 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8270 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8271 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8272 address.
8273
8274 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8275 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8276 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8277 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8278 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8279 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8280 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8281 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8282 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8283 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8284
8285 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8286 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8287 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8288 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8289 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8290 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8291 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8292
8293 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8294 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8295 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8296 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8297
8298 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8299 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8300 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8301 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8302 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8303 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008304 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8305 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8306 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8307 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8308 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8309 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008310
8311 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8312 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8313 the request.
8314
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008315 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8316 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8317 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8318
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008319 Example :
8320 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8321 # last 30 minutes
8322 backend pop
8323 mode tcp
8324 balance roundrobin
8325 stick store-request src
8326 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8327 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8328 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8329
8330 backend smtp
8331 mode tcp
8332 balance roundrobin
8333 stick match src table pop
8334 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8335 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8336
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008337 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008338 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008339
8340
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008341stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008342 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8343 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008344 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008346 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008347
8348 Arguments :
8349 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8350 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8351 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8352 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8353
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008354 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8355 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8356 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8357 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8358
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008359 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8360 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8361 instance.
8362
8363 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8364 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8365 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8366 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8367 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8368 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008369 to 32 characters.
8370
8371 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8372 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8373 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008374 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008375 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8376 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008377
8378 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008379 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8380 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008381 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8382 increase.
8383
8384 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008385 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8386 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8387 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008388
8389 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8390 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8391 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8392 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8393 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8394 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8395 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8396 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8397 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8398 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8399 parameter (see below).
8400
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008401 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8402 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8403 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8404 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8405 soft restart.
8406
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008407 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8408 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008409
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008410 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8411 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8412 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8413 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8414 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008415 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008416 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8417 if not expiration delay is specified.
8418
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008419 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8420 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8421 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8422 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008423 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8424 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8425 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8426 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8427 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8428 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8429 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8430 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8431 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8432 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8433 types and their arguments.
8434
8435 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8436 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8437 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8438 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8439
8440 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8441 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8442 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8443 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8444
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008445 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8446 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8447 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8448 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8449 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8450 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8451
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008452 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8453 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8454 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8455 they were received.
8456
8457 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8458 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8459 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8460 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8461 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8462
8463 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8464 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8465 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8466 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8467 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8468
8469 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8470 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8471 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8472
8473 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8474 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8475 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8476 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8477 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8478
8479 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8480 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8481 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8482 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8483 the client side.
8484
8485 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8486 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8487 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8488 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8489 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8490 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8491 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8492
8493 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8494 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8495 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8496 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8497 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8498 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8499 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8500
8501 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8502 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8503 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8504 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8505 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8506 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8507
8508 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8509 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8510 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8511 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8512
8513 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8514 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8515 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8516 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8517 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8518 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8519 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8520 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8521 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8522 recommended for better fairness.
8523
8524 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8525 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8526 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8527 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8528
8529 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8530 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8531 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8532 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8533 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8534 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8535 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8536 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8537 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8538 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008539
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008540 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8541 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008542 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8543 reference it.
8544
8545 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8546 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008547 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8548 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8549 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008550
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008551 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8552 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8553 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8554 something that can be ignored.
8555
8556 Example:
8557 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8558 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8559 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8560 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8561
8562 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008563 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008564
8565
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008566stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008567 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8569 no | no | yes | yes
8570
8571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008572 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008573 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8574 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8575 server is selected.
8576
8577 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8578 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8579 the "stick-table" statement.
8580
8581 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8582 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8583 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8584 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8585
8586 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8587 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8588 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8589 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8590 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8591 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008592 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008593 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8594 rules.
8595
8596 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8597 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8598 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8599 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8600 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8601 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8602 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8603
8604 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8605 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8606 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8607 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8608
8609 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8610 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8611 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8612 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8613 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8614 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008615 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8616 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8617 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8618 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8619 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8620 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8621 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8622 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8623 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008624
8625 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8626
8627 Example :
8628 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8629 backend https
8630 mode tcp
8631 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008632 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008633 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008634
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008635 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8636 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8637
8638 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8639 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8640 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8641
8642 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8643 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008644
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008645 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8646 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8647 # at offset 44.
8648
8649 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8650 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8651
8652 # Learn on response if server hello.
8653 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008654
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008655 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8656 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8657
8658 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8659 extraction.
8660
8661
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008662tcp-check connect [params*]
8663 Opens a new connection
8664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 no | no | yes | yes
8666
8667 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8668 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8669 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8670
8671 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8672 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8673 of the sequence.
8674
8675 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8676 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8677 do.
8678
8679 Parameters :
8680 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8681 use the TCP connection.
8682
8683 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8684 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8685 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8686
8687 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8688
8689 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8690
8691 Examples:
8692 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8693 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8694 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8695 option tcp-check
8696 tcp-check connect
8697 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8698 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8699 tcp-check send \r\n
8700 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8701 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8702 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8703 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8704 tcp-check send \r\n
8705 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8706 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8707
8708 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8709 option tcp-check
8710 tcp-check connect port 110
8711 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8712 tcp-check connect port 143
8713 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8714 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8715
8716 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8717
8718
8719tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8720 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8722 no | no | yes | yes
8723
8724 Arguments :
8725 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8726 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8727 binary.
8728 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8729 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8730 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8731
8732 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8733 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8734 with the usual backslash ('\').
8735 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8736 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8737 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8738 used upper or lower case.
8739
8740
8741 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8742
8743 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8744 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8745 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8746 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8747 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8748 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8749 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8750 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8751
8752 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8753 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8754 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8755 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8756 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8757 expression.
8758
8759 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8760 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8761 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8762 this exact hexadecimal string.
8763 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8764
8765 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8766 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8767 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8768 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8769 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8770 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8771 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8772 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8773 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8774 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8775 the null character.
8776
8777 Examples :
8778 # perform a POP check
8779 option tcp-check
8780 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8781
8782 # perform an IMAP check
8783 option tcp-check
8784 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8785
8786 # look for the redis master server
8787 option tcp-check
8788 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008789 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008790 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8791 tcp-check expect string role:master
8792 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8793 tcp-check expect string +OK
8794
8795
8796 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8797 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8798
8799
8800tcp-check send <data>
8801 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8803 no | no | yes | yes
8804
8805 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8806 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8807
8808 Examples :
8809 # look for the redis master server
8810 option tcp-check
8811 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8812 tcp-check expect string role:master
8813
8814 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8815 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8816
8817
8818tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8819 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8820 tcp health check
8821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8822 no | no | yes | yes
8823
8824 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8825 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8826 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8827 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8828 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8829 hexadecimal string.
8830 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8831
8832 Examples :
8833 # redis check in binary
8834 option tcp-check
8835 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8836 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8837
8838
8839 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8840 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8841
8842
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008843tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8844 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8846 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008848 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8849 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008850
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008851 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008852
8853 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8854 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008855 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8856 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8857 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8858 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8859 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8860 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008862 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8863 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8864 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8865 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008866
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008867 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008868 - accept :
8869 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8870 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8871 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008873 - reject :
8874 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8875 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8876 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8877 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8878 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8879 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8880 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8881 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8882 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8883 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8884 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008885 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008886
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008887 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8888 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8889 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8890 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8891 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8892 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8893 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8894 hosts.
8895
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008896 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8897 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8898 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8899 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8900 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8901 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8902 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8903 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8904
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008905 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8906 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8907 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8908 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8909 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8910 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8911 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8912 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8913 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008914 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8915 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008916
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008917 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008918 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008919 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008920 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008921 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8922 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008923 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008924 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8925 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8926 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8927 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8928 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008929
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008930 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008931 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008932 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008933 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8934 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8935 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8936 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008938 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8939 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8940 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8941 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008943 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8944 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8945 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8946 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8947 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008948 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8949 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8950 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8951 layer7 information is extracted.
8952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008953 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8954 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8955 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8956 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8957 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008958
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008959 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8960 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8961 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8962 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8963
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008964 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8965 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8966 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8967 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8968 continues.
8969
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008970 - set-src <expr> :
8971 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8972 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8973 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8974 set-src"
8975
8976 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8977 followed by some converters.
8978
8979 Example:
8980
8981 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8982
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008983 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8984 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008985
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008986 - set-src-port <expr> :
8987 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8988 expression.
8989
8990 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8991 followed by some converters.
8992
8993 Example:
8994
8995 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8996
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008997 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8998 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8999 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009000
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009001 - set-dst <expr> :
9002 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9003 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9004 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9005 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9006 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9007
9008 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9009 followed by some converters.
9010
9011 Example:
9012
9013 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9014 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9015
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009016 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9017 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9018
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009019 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9020 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9021 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9022 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9023
9024
9025 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9026 followed by some converters.
9027
9028 Example:
9029
9030 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9031
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009032 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9033 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9034 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9035
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009036 - "silent-drop" :
9037 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9038 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9039 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9040 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9041 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9042 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9043 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9044 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9045 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9046 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9047 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9048 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9049 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9050 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9051 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9052 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009054 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9055 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9056 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9059 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9060 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009062 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009063 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009064 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009066 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9067 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9068 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009070 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009071 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9072 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009073
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009074 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9075
9076 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9077
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009078 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9079
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009080 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009081
9082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009083tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9084 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009086 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009087 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009088 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9089 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009091 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009093 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9094 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9095 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9096 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9097 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009099 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9100 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9101 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9102 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009103 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9104 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9105 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9106 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9107 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9108 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009109 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009110 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009112 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9113 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9114 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9115 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009116
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009117 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009118 - accept : the request is accepted
9119 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9120 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009121 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009122 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009123 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009124 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009125 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009126 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009128 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9129 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009130
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009131 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9132 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9133 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9134 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9135 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9136 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009138 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009139 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9140 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009142 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009143 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9144 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9145 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9146 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009147 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9148 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9149 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009150
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009151 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009152 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9153 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9154 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009155
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009156 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009157 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9158 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009160 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9161 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009162 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009163 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9164 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009165 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009166 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009167 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009168 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9169 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009170 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009171 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9172 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009173
9174 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9175 followed by some converters.
9176
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009177 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9178 <var-name>.
9179
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009180 Example:
9181
9182 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009183 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009184
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009185 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9187 # and reject everything else.
9188 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9189 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009190 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 tcp-request content reject
9192
9193 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009194 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9195 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9196 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009197 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009198
9199 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9200 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9201 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009202 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009203 tcp-request content reject
9204
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009205 Example:
9206 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9207 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009208 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009209
9210 Example:
9211 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9212 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009213 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009215 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9216 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9217
9218 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009219 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009220 # protecting all our sites
9221 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009222 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9223 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009224 ...
9225 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9226
9227 backend http_dynamic
9228 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009229 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009230 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009231 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9232 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9233 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009234 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009236 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009237
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009238 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9239 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009240
9241
9242tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9243 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009245 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009246 Arguments :
9247 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9248 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9249 as explained at the top of this document.
9250
9251 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9252 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9253 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9254 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9255 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9256
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009257 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9258 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9259 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9260 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9261
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009262 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9263 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009264 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009265 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009266 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9267 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9268 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9269 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009270
9271 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9272 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9273 it pass through unaffected.
9274
9275 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9276 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9277 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009278 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009279 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9280 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009281 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9282 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9283 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009284
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009285 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009286 "timeout client".
9287
9288
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009289tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9290 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9292 no | no | yes | yes
9293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009294 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9295 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009296
9297 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9298
9299 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9300 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9301 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009302 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9303 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009304
9305 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9306
9307 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9308 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9309 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9310 inserted.
9311
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009312 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009313 - accept :
9314 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9315 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9316 the rules evaluation.
9317
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009318 - close :
9319 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9320 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9321 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9322 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9323 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9324 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009325 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009326 protocols.
9327
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009328 - reject :
9329 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9330 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009331 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009332
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009333 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9334 Sets a variable.
9335
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009336 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9337 Unsets a variable.
9338
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009339 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9340 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9341 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9342 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9343
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009344 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9345 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9346 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9347 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9348 continues.
9349
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009350 - "silent-drop" :
9351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9352 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9353 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9354 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9355 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9356 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9357 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9358 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9359 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9360 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9361 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9362 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9363 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9364 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9365 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9366 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9367
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009368 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9369 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9370 for changing the default action to a reject.
9371
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009372 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9373 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9374 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9375 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009376 period.
9377
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009378 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9379 declared inline.
9380
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009381 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9382 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009383 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009384 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9385 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009386 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009387 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009388 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009389 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9390 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009391 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009392 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9393 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009394
9395 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9396 followed by some converters.
9397
9398 Example:
9399
9400 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9401
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009402 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9403 <var-name>.
9404
9405 Example:
9406
9407 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9408
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009409 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9410
9411 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9412
9413
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009414tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9415 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9417 no | yes | yes | no
9418 Arguments :
9419 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9420 below.
9421
9422 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9423
9424 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9425 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9426 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9427 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9428 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9429 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9430 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9431 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9432 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9433 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9434 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9435 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9436 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9437 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9438 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9439 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9440 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9441 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9442 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9443 instead.
9444
9445 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9446 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9447 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9448 rules which may be inserted.
9449
9450 Several types of actions are supported :
9451 - accept : the request is accepted
9452 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9453 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9454 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9455 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9456 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009457 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009458 - silent-drop
9459
9460 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9461 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9462 sections for a complete description.
9463
9464 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9465 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9466 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9467
9468 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9469 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9470 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9471 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9472 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9473
9474 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9475 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9476
9477 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9478 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9479 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9480
9481 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9482 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9483 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9484
9485 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9486 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9487 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9488
9489 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9490 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9491 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9492
9493 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9494
9495 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9496
9497
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009498tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9499 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9501 no | no | yes | yes
9502 Arguments :
9503 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9505 as explained at the top of this document.
9506
9507 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9508
9509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009510timeout check <timeout>
9511 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9512 established.
9513
9514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 yes | no | yes | yes
9516 Arguments:
9517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9519 as explained at the top of this document.
9520
9521 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9522 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9523 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9524 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009525 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9526 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9527 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009528
9529 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9530 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9531
9532 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9533 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009534 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009535
9536 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9538 forget about it.
9539
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009540 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9541 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009542
9543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009544timeout client <timeout>
9545timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9546 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9548 yes | yes | yes | no
9549 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9552 as explained at the top of this document.
9553
9554 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9555 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9556 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009557 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9558 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9559 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9560 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009561 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9562 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9563 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009564 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009565 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009566 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9567 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009568 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9569 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009570
9571 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9572 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9573 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9574 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9575 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9576 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9577
9578 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9579 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9580 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9581
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009582 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9583 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009584
9585
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009586timeout client-fin <timeout>
9587 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9589 yes | yes | yes | no
9590 Arguments :
9591 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9592 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9593 as explained at the top of this document.
9594
9595 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9596 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9597 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9598 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9599 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9600 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9601 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9602 down in one direction.
9603
9604 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9605 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9606 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9607
9608 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9609
9610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009611timeout connect <timeout>
9612timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9613 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | no | yes | yes
9616 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009617 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009618 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9619 as explained at the top of this document.
9620
9621 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009622 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009623 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009624 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009625 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9626 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009627
9628 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9629 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9630 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9631 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9632 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9633 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9634
9635 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9636 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9637 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9638
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009639 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9640 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009641
9642
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009643timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9644 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9646 yes | yes | yes | yes
9647 Arguments :
9648 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9649 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9650 as explained at the top of this document.
9651
9652 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9653 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9654 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9655 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9656 once the request has started to present itself.
9657
9658 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9659 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9660 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9661 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9662 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9663
9664 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9665 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9666 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9667 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9668
9669 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9670 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9671 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9672 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9673 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009674 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009675
9676 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9677 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9678 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9679 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9680
9681 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9682
9683
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009684timeout http-request <timeout>
9685 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009688 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009689 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009690 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9691 as explained at the top of this document.
9692
9693 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9694 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9695 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9696 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9697 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9698 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9699 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009700 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9701 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9702 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9703 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9704 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009705 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9706 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009707
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009708 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9709 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9710 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9711 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9712 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009713 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009714
9715 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9716 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9717 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9718 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9719 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9720
9721 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009722 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9723 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9724 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009725
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009726 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009727 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009728
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009729
9730timeout queue <timeout>
9731 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9733 yes | no | yes | yes
9734 Arguments :
9735 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9736 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9737 as explained at the top of this document.
9738
9739 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9740 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9741 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9742 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9743 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9744
9745 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9746 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9747 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9748 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9749
9750 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9751
9752
9753timeout server <timeout>
9754timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9755 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9757 yes | no | yes | yes
9758 Arguments :
9759 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9760 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9761 as explained at the top of this document.
9762
9763 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9764 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9765 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9766 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9767 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9768 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9769 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9770
9771 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9772 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9773 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9774 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9775 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009776 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009777 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009778 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9779 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9780 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9781 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009782
9783 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9784 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9785 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9786 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9787 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9788 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9789
9790 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9791 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9792 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9793
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009794 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009795
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009796
9797timeout server-fin <timeout>
9798 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9800 yes | no | yes | yes
9801 Arguments :
9802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9804 as explained at the top of this document.
9805
9806 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9807 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9808 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9809 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9810 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9811 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9812 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9813 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9814 situations, it should not be needed.
9815
9816 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9817 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9818 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9819
9820 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9821
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009822
9823timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009824 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9826 yes | yes | yes | yes
9827 Arguments :
9828 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9829 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9830 as explained at the top of this document.
9831
9832 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9833 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9834 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9835
9836 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9837 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9838 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9839 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009840 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009841
9842 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9843
9844
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009845timeout tunnel <timeout>
9846 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9848 yes | no | yes | yes
9849 Arguments :
9850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9852 as explained at the top of this document.
9853
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009854 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009855 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9856 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9857 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9858 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9859 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9860 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9861 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9862 specified.
9863
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009864 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9865 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9866 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9867 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9868 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9869 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9870 state.
9871
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009872 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9873 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9874 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9875 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9876 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9877
9878 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9879 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9880 forget about it.
9881
9882 Example :
9883 defaults http
9884 option http-server-close
9885 timeout connect 5s
9886 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009887 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009888 timeout server 30s
9889 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9890
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009891 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009892
9893
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009894transparent (deprecated)
9895 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009897 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009898 Arguments : none
9899
9900 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9901 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9902 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9903 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9904 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9905 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9906 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9907 appropriate server.
9908
9909 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9910
9911 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9912 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9913
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009914 See also: "option transparent"
9915
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009916unique-id-format <string>
9917 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9919 yes | yes | yes | no
9920 Arguments :
9921 <string> is a log-format string.
9922
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009923 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9924 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9925 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9926 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009927
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009928 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9929 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9930 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9931 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9932 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9933 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9934 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9935 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009936
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009937 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9938 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009939
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009940 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009941
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009942 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009943
9944 will generate:
9945
9946 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9947
9948 See also: "unique-id-header"
9949
9950unique-id-header <name>
9951 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9953 yes | yes | yes | no
9954 Arguments :
9955 <name> is the name of the header.
9956
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009957 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9958 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009959
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009960 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009961
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009962 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009963 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9964
9965 will generate:
9966
9967 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9968
9969 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009970
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009971use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009972 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9974 no | yes | yes | no
9975 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009976 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9977 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009978
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009979 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9980 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009981
9982 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9983 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9984 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009985 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9986 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9987 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9988 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009989
9990 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9991 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9992 assign the backend.
9993
9994 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9995 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9996 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9997 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9998 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9999 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10000
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010001 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010002 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010003 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10004 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10005 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10006
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010007 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10008 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10009 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10010 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10011 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10012 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10013 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10014 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10015 cannot be forced from the request.
10016
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010017 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010018 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10019 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10020
10021 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10022 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010023
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010024
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010025use-server <server> if <condition>
10026use-server <server> unless <condition>
10027 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10029 no | no | yes | yes
10030 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010031 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010032
10033 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10034
10035 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10036 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10037 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10038
10039 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10040 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10041 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10042 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10043 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10044 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10045 matches will assign the server.
10046
10047 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10048 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10049 with the next rules until one matches.
10050
10051 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10052 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10053 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10054 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10055
10056 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10057 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10058 stripped.
10059
10060 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10061 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10062 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10063 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10064
10065 Example :
10066 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10067 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10068 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10069 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10070 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10071 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
10072 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
10073 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10074 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10075
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010076 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010077
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010078
100795. Bind and Server options
10080--------------------------
10081
10082The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10083depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10084settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10085written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10086described in this section.
10087
10088
100895.1. Bind options
10090-----------------
10091
10092The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10093as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10094no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10095parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10096while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10097provided immediately after the setting name.
10098
10099The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10100
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010101accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10102 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10103 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10104 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10105 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10106 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10107 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10108 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10109 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10110 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010111 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10112 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10113 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010114
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010115accept-proxy
10116 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010117 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10118 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010119 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10120 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10121 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10122 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10123 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10124 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10125 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010126 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10127 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010128
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010129alpn <protocols>
10130 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10131 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10132 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10133 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10134 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10135 initial NPN extension.
10136
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010137backlog <backlog>
10138 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10139 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10140
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010141curves <curves>
10142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10143 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10144 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10145 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10146 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10147 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10148
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010149ecdhe <named curve>
10150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010151 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10152 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010153
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010154ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010155 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10156 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10157 client's certificate.
10158
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010159ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10161 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10162 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10163 error is ignored.
10164
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010165ca-sign-file <cafile>
10166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10167 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10168 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10169 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10170 'generate-certificates' for details.
10171
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010172ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10174 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10175 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10176 'generate-certificates' for details.
10177
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010178ciphers <ciphers>
10179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10180 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010182 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10183 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10184
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010185crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10187 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10188 to verify client's certificate.
10189
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010190crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10192 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10193 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10194 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10195 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10196 file.
10197
10198 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10199 are loaded.
10200
10201 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010202 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010203 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10204 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10205 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10206 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10207 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10208 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10209 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010210
10211 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10212 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10213 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10214 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010215 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10216 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010217
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010218 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010219
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010220 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10221 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010222 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010223 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10224 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10225 clients).
10226
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010227 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10228 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10229 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10230 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10231 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10232 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10233 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10234 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10235 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10236 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10237 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10238 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10239 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10240
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010241 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10242 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10243 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10244 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10245 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10246
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010247 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10248 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10249 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10250 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010251
10252 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10253 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10254 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10255 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10256 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10257 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10258 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10259 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10260 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10261
10262 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10263
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010264 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010265 a cert bundle.
10266
10267 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10268 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10269 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10270 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10271 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10272 provide multi-cert support.
10273
10274 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10275
10276 Filename | CN | SAN
10277 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10278 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010279 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010280 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10281 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10282
10283 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10284 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10285 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10286 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010287 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10288 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010289
10290 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10291 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10292
10293 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10294 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10295 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10296
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010297crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10299 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010300 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010301 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010302
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010303crt-list <file>
10304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010305 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10306 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010307
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010308 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10309
10310 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010311 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010312 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010313
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010314 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10315 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10316 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10317 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10318 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10319 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10320 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10321 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010322
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010323 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010324 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010325 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10326 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10327 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010328
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010329 crt-list file example:
10330 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010331 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010332 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010333 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010335defer-accept
10336 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10337 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10338 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10339 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10340 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10341 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10342 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10343 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10344 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10345 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10346 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10347
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010348force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010349 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010350 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010351 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10352 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010353
10354force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010356 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10357 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010358
10359force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010360 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010361 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10362 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010363
10364force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010365 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010366 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10367 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010368
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010369generate-certificates
10370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10371 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10372 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10373 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10374 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10375 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10376 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10377 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10378 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10379 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10380 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10381
10382 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10383 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10384 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10385 certificate is used many times.
10386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010387gid <gid>
10388 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10389 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10390 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10391 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10392 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10393
10394group <group>
10395 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10396 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10397 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10398 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10399 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10400
10401id <id>
10402 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10403 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10404 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10405 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10406
10407interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010408 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10409 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10410 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10411 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10412 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10413 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10414 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010415
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010416level <level>
10417 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10418 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10419 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10420 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10421 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10422 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10423 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10424 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10425 counters).
10426 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10427 all counters).
10428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010429maxconn <maxconn>
10430 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10431 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10432 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10433 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10434 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10435 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10436 eat all memory.
10437
10438mode <mode>
10439 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10440 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10441 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10442 UNIX sockets.
10443
10444mss <maxseg>
10445 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10446 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10447 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10448 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10449 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10450 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10451 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10452 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10453 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10454 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10455 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10456
10457name <name>
10458 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10459 page.
10460
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010461namespace <name>
10462 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10463 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10464 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10465 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010467nice <nice>
10468 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10469 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10470 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10471 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10472 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10473 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10474 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10475 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10476 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10477 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10478 one for an RDP socket.
10479
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010480no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010482 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010483 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010484 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10485 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010486 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010487
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010488no-tls-tickets
10489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10490 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10491 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010492 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10493 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010494
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010495no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010497 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010498 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010499 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10500 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10501 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010502
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010503no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010505 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010506 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010507 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10508 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10509 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010510
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010511no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010513 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010514 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010515 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10516 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10517 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010518
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010519npn <protocols>
10520 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10521 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10522 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10523 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010524 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10525 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010526
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010527process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10528 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10529 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10530 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10531 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10532 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10533 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10534 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010535 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10536 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10537 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10538 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10539 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10540 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10541 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010542
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010543ssl
10544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010545 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010546 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10547 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10548 to deciphered contents.
10549
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010550strict-sni
10551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10552 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10553 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10554 See the "crt" option for more information.
10555
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010556tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010557 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010558 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10559 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010560 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010561 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10562 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10563 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10564 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10565 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10566 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10567 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10568
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010569tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010570 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010571 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10572 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10573 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10574 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10575 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10576 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10577 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010578 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10579 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10580 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010581
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010582tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10583 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10584 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10585 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10586 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10587 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10588 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10589 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10590 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10591 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10592 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10593
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010594transparent
10595 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10596 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10597 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10598 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10599 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10600 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10601 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10602 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10603 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10604 so check for support with your vendor.
10605
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010606v4v6
10607 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10608 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10609 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10610 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010611 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010612
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010613v6only
10614 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10615 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10616 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010617 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10618 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010620uid <uid>
10621 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10622 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10623 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10624 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10625 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10626
10627user <user>
10628 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10629 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10630 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10631 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10632 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10633
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010634verify [none|optional|required]
10635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10636 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10637 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10638 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10639 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010640 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10641 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10642 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10643 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010644
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106455.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010646------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010648The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10649which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10650arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10651settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10652after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10653Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10654address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010656 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010657 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010659The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010660
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010661addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010662 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010663 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10664 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10665 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10666 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10667 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010669 Supported in default-server: No
10670
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010671agent-check
10672 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010673 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10674 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10675 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10676 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010677
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010678 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010679 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010680 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10681 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10682 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010683
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010684 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10685 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10686 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10687 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10688 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10689
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010690 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10691 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010692
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010693 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10694 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10695 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010696
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010697 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10698 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10699 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010701 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10702 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10703 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10704 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10705 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10706 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10707 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010708
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010709 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10710 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010711
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010712 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10713 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10714 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10715 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10716 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10717 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10718 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10719 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10720 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010721
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010722 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10723 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010724 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10725 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10726 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010727 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010729 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10730 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010731
10732 Supported in default-server: No
10733
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010734agent-send <string>
10735 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10736 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10737 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10738 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10739 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10740
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010741agent-inter <delay>
10742 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10743 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10744
10745 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10746 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10747 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10748 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10749 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10750 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10751 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10752 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10753 of backends use the same servers.
10754
10755 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10756
10757 Supported in default-server: Yes
10758
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010759agent-addr <addr>
10760 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10761
10762 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10763 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10764 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10765 hostname, it will be resolved.
10766
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010767agent-port <port>
10768 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10769
10770 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10771
10772 Supported in default-server: Yes
10773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010774backup
10775 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10776 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10777 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10778 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10779 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10780 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010782 Supported in default-server: No
10783
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010784ca-file <cafile>
10785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10786 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10787 server's certificate.
10788
10789 Supported in default-server: No
10790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010791check
10792 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010793 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10794 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10795 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10796 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10797 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10798 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10799 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010800 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10801 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10802 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010804 Supported in default-server: No
10805
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010806check-send-proxy
10807 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10808 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10809 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10810 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10811 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10812 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10813 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10814
10815 Supported in default-server: No
10816
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010817check-ssl
10818 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10819 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10820 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10821 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010822 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010823 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10824 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10825 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10826 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10827
10828 Supported in default-server: No
10829
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010830ciphers <ciphers>
10831 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010832 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010833 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10834 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10835 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10836 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10837 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10838 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10839
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010840 Supported in default-server: No
10841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010842cookie <value>
10843 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10844 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10845 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10846 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10847 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10848 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10849 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010851 Supported in default-server: No
10852
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010853crl-file <crlfile>
10854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10855 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10856 to verify server's certificate.
10857
10858 Supported in default-server: No
10859
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010860crt <cert>
10861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10862 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10863 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10864 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10865 certificate request.
10866
10867 Supported in default-server: No
10868
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010869disabled
10870 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10871 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10872 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10873 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10874 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10875
10876 Supported in default-server: No
10877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010878error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010879 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10880 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10881 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010883 Supported in default-server: Yes
10884
10885 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010887fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010888 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10889 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10890 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010892 Supported in default-server: Yes
10893
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010894force-sslv3
10895 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10896 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010897 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10898 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010899
10900 Supported in default-server: No
10901
10902force-tlsv10
10903 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010904 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10905 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010906
10907 Supported in default-server: No
10908
10909force-tlsv11
10910 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010911 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10912 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010913
10914 Supported in default-server: No
10915
10916force-tlsv12
10917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010918 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10919 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010920
10921 Supported in default-server: No
10922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010923id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010924 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10925 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10926 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010928 Supported in default-server: No
10929
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010930init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10931 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10932 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10933 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10934 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10935 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10936 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10937 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10938 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10939 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10940 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10941 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10942 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10943 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10944 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10945 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10946 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10947 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10948 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10949 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10950 historic behaviour.
10951
10952 Example:
10953 defaults
10954 # never fail on address resolution
10955 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10956
10957 Supported in default-server: Yes
10958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010959inter <delay>
10960fastinter <delay>
10961downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010962 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10963 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10964 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10965 between checks depending on the server state :
10966
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010967 Server state | Interval used
10968 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10969 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10970 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10971 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10972 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10973 or yet unchecked. |
10974 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10975 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10976 | "inter" otherwise.
10977 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010979 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10980 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10981 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10982 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010983 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10984 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10985 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10986 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10987 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010989 Supported in default-server: Yes
10990
10991maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010992 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10993 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10994 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10995 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10996 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10997 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10998 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10999 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011001 Supported in default-server: Yes
11002
11003maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011004 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11005 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11006 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11007 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11008 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11009 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11010 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011012 Supported in default-server: Yes
11013
11014minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011015 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11016 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11017 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11018 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11019 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11020 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011021 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011022 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011024 Supported in default-server: Yes
11025
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011026namespace <name>
11027 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11028 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11029 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11030 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11031
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011032no-ssl-reuse
11033 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11034 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11035 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11036 and for paranoid users.
11037
11038 Supported in default-server: No
11039
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011040no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011041 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11042 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011043 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011044
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011045 Supported in default-server: No
11046
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011047no-tls-tickets
11048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11049 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11050 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011051 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11052 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011053
11054 Supported in default-server: No
11055
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011056no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011057 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011058 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11059 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011060 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11061 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11062 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011063
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011064 Supported in default-server: No
11065
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011066no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011067 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011068 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11069 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011070 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11071 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11072 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011073
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011074 Supported in default-server: No
11075
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011076no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011077 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011078 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11079 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011080 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11081 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11082 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011083
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011084 Supported in default-server: No
11085
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011086non-stick
11087 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11088 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11089 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11090
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011091 Supported in default-server: No
11092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011093observe <mode>
11094 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11095 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11096 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11097 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11098 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11099 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011100 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011102 Supported in default-server: No
11103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011104 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011106on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011107 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11108 Currently, four modes are available:
11109 - fastinter: force fastinter
11110 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11111 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11112 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11113 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011115 Supported in default-server: Yes
11116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011117 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11118
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011119on-marked-down <action>
11120 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11121 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011122 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11123 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11124 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11125 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11126 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11127 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11128 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11129 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011130
11131 Actions are disabled by default
11132
11133 Supported in default-server: Yes
11134
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011135on-marked-up <action>
11136 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11137 Currently one action is available:
11138 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11139 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11140 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11141 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11142 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11143 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11144 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11145 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11146
11147 Actions are disabled by default
11148
11149 Supported in default-server: Yes
11150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011151port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011152 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11153 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11154 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11155 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11156 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11157 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011159 Supported in default-server: Yes
11160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011161redir <prefix>
11162 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11163 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11164 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11165 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11166 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11167 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11168 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11169 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011170 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011171 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11172 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11173 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11174 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11175 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11176
11177 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011179 Supported in default-server: No
11180
11181rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011182 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11183 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11184 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011186 Supported in default-server: Yes
11187
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011188resolve-prefer <family>
11189 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11190 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11191 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11192 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11193
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011194 Default value: ipv6
11195
11196 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011198 Example:
11199
11200 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011201
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011202resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11203 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11204 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011205 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011206 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11207 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11208 configured network, another address is selected.
11209
11210 Supported in default-server: Yes
11211
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011212 Example:
11213
11214 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011215
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011216resolvers <id>
11217 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11218 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011219 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11220 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11221 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11222 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011223
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011224 Supported in default-server: No
11225
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011226 Example:
11227
11228 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011229
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011230 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011231
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011232send-proxy
11233 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11234 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11235 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11236 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011237 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11238 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11239 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11240 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11241 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11242 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11243 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11244 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11245 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11246 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11247 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11248 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011249
11250 Supported in default-server: No
11251
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011252send-proxy-v2
11253 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11254 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11255 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11256 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11257 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11258 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11259 option of the "bind" keyword.
11260
11261 Supported in default-server: No
11262
11263send-proxy-v2-ssl
11264 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11265 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11266 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11267 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11268 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11269 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11270 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11271 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11272
11273 Supported in default-server: No
11274
11275send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11276 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11277 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11278 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11279 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11280 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11281 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11282 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11283 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11284 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11285
11286 Supported in default-server: No
11287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011288slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011289 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11290 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11291 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11292 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11293 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11294 parameters :
11295
11296 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11297 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11298
11299 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11300 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11301 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11302 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11303
11304 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11305 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11306 seen as failed.
11307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011308 Supported in default-server: Yes
11309
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011310sni <expression>
11311 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11312 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11313 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11314 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11315 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11316
11317 Supported in default-server: no
11318
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011319source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011320source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011321source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011322 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11323 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11324 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11325 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11326
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011327 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11328 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11329 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11330 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11331 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11332 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11333 server.
11334
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011335 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11336 specifying the source address without port(s).
11337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011338 Supported in default-server: No
11339
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011340ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011341 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11342 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11343 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11344 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11345 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11346 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011347 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011348
11349 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011350
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011351tcp-ut <delay>
11352 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11353 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11354 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011355 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011356 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11357 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11358 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11359 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11360 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11361 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11362 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11363 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11364 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011366track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011367 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11368 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11369 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11370 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011371 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011373 Supported in default-server: No
11374
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011375verify [none|required]
11376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011377 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11378 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11379 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11380 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011381 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11382 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11383 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011384
11385 Supported in default-server: No
11386
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011387verifyhost <hostname>
11388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11389 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11390 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11391 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11392 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11393 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11394
11395 Supported in default-server: No
11396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011397weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011398 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11399 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11400 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011401 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11402 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11403 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11404 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11405 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11406 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011408 Supported in default-server: Yes
11409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011410
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114115.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11412-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011413
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011414HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11415using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11416configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011417This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11418can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11419workload.
11420This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11421resolution at run time.
11422Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11423carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11424
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011425Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11426health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11427
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011428
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114295.3.1. Global overview
11430----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011431
11432As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11433different steps of the process life:
11434
11435 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11436 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11437 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11438
11439 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11440 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11441 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11442
11443A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11444 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11445 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11446 resolution to know this new IP.
11447
11448A few things important to notice:
11449 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11450 first valid response.
11451
11452 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11453 servers return an error.
11454
11455
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114565.3.2. The resolvers section
11457----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011458
11459This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11460HAProxy.
11461There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11462many name servers.
11463
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011464When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11465uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11466is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11467answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11468
11469When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11470used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11471
11472Two types of behavior can be applied:
11473 1. stop DNS resolution
11474 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11475 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11476 1. ANY query type
11477 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11478 server's parameter
11479 3. remaining family type
11480
11481HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11482 - invalid DNS response packet
11483 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11484 - NX domain
11485 - Query refused by server
11486 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11487
11488HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11489 - no Answer records in the response
11490 - DNS response truncated
11491 - Error in DNS response
11492 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11493 - name server timeout
11494
11495For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11496 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11497 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11498 applied;
11499 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11500 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11501 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11502 stops resolution.
11503
11504
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011505resolvers <resolvers id>
11506 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11507
11508A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11509
11510nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11511 DNS server description:
11512 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11513 <ip> : IP address of the server
11514 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11515
11516hold <status> <period>
11517 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11518 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011519 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11520 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011521 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11522 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11523 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11524
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011525 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011526
11527 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11528 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11529 the healch check.
11530
11531resolve_retries <nb>
11532 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11533 giving up.
11534 Default value: 3
11535
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011536 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11537 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11538 type.
11539
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011540timeout <event> <time>
11541 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11542 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11543 events available are:
11544 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11545 been received.
11546 Default value: 1s
11547 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11548 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11549
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011550 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011551
11552 resolvers mydns
11553 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11554 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11555 resolve_retries 3
11556 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011557 hold other 30s
11558 hold refused 30s
11559 hold nx 30s
11560 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011561 hold valid 10s
11562
11563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115646. HTTP header manipulation
11565---------------------------
11566
11567In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11568response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11569request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11570which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011571against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011573If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11574to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11575but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11576HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11577stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11578because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11579a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11580still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011582This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11583in section 4.2 :
11584
11585 - reqadd <string>
11586 - reqallow <search>
11587 - reqiallow <search>
11588 - reqdel <search>
11589 - reqidel <search>
11590 - reqdeny <search>
11591 - reqideny <search>
11592 - reqpass <search>
11593 - reqipass <search>
11594 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11595 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11596 - reqtarpit <search>
11597 - reqitarpit <search>
11598 - rspadd <string>
11599 - rspdel <search>
11600 - rspidel <search>
11601 - rspdeny <search>
11602 - rspideny <search>
11603 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11604 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11605
11606With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11607is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11608parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11609prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11610Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11611
11612 \t for a tab
11613 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11614 \n for a new line (LF)
11615 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11616 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11617 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11618 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11619 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11620
11621The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11622portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11623above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11624regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
116259 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11626is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11627
11628The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11629after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11630
11631Notes related to these keywords :
11632---------------------------------
11633 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11634 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11635 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11636
11637 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11638 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11639 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11640
11641 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11642 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11643 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11644 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11645 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11646
11647 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11648 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11649 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11650 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11651 useless headers before adding new ones.
11652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011653 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011654 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11655
11656 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11657 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11658 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11659
11660 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11661 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011662 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011663
11664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116657. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11666----------------------------------
11667
11668Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11669client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11670The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11671these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11672but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11673data called patterns.
11674
11675
116767.1. ACL basics
11677---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011678
11679The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11680content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11681from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11682simple :
11683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011684 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011685 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011686 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11687 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11690adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011691
11692In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011695
11696This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11697Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11698and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011699an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11700conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11701as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11702are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703
11704ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11705'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11706which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11707
11708There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11709performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11712specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11713this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011714methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11715ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011716
11717Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11718 - boolean
11719 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11720 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11721 - string
11722 - data block
11723
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011724Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11725converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11726would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11727The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11728which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11729
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011730Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11731keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11732fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11733which are summarized in the table below :
11734
11735 +---------------------+-----------------+
11736 | Sample or converter | Default |
11737 | output type | matching method |
11738 +---------------------+-----------------+
11739 | boolean | bool |
11740 +---------------------+-----------------+
11741 | integer | int |
11742 +---------------------+-----------------+
11743 | ip | ip |
11744 +---------------------+-----------------+
11745 | string | str |
11746 +---------------------+-----------------+
11747 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11748 +---------------------+-----------------+
11749
11750Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11751matching method, see below.
11752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11754 - boolean
11755 - integer or integer range
11756 - IP address / network
11757 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11758 - regular expression
11759 - hex block
11760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011761The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11762
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011763 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11764 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011766 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011767 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011768 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011769 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011771The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11772read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11773if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11774lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11775will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11776beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11777a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11778lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11779exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11780
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011781The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11782parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11783ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11784a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11785check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11786
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011787The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11788socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11789file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11792loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11793
11794 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11795
11796In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11797the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11798case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11799as well.
11800
11801The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11802sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11803do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11804methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11805is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11806obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11807followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11808default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11809that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11810string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11811
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011812The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11813By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11814string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11815resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11816server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11817waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11818flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11819function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11822sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11823be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011824
11825 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11826 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011827 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11828 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11829 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11830 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011831
11832 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11833 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011835
11836 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011838
11839 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011840 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011841
11842 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11843 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11844
11845 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11846 binary or string samples.
11847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11849 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11852 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11853 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011855 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11856 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011858 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11859 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11862 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11865 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011866 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011868 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11869 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11870 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011871
11872For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11873request, it is possible to do :
11874
11875 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11876
11877In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11878buffer, one would use the following acl :
11879
11880 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11881
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011882On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11883possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11884
11885 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11888criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11889method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11890to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11891criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11892the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011894If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011895the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11896For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11899 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11900 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11901 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011902
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011903
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011904The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11905types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11906combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11907brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11908default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910 +-------------------------------------------------+
11911 | Input sample type |
11912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011913 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11915 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011917 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011919 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011921 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011923 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011925 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011927 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011929 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011931 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011933 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011935 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011937 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11939 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11940 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011941
11942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119437.1.1. Matching booleans
11944------------------------
11945
11946In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11947Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11948When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11949that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11950
11951Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11952return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11953"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119567.1.2. Matching integers
11957------------------------
11958
11959Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11960enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11961to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11962
11963Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11964matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11965lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011966
11967For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11968unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11969representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11970
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011971As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11972two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11973instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11974ranges and operators.
11975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011976For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011977operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11978Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11979of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011981Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011982
11983 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11984 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11985 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11986 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11987 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011989For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011990
11991 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11992
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011993This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11994
11995 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119987.1.3. Matching strings
11999-----------------------
12000
12001String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12002different forms :
12003
12004 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12005 patterns ;
12006
12007 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12008 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12009
12010 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12011 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12012
12013 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12014 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12015
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012016 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012017 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12018 matches.
12019
12020 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12021 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12022 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012023
12024String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12025exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12026characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12027string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12028to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012029before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012030
12031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120327.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12033---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012034
12035Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12036they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12037possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12038passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12039the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012040the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12041match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012042
12043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120447.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12045-------------------------------------
12046
12047It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12048not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12049a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12050to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12051digits may be used upper or lower case.
12052
12053Example :
12054 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12055 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12056
12057
120587.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12059---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012060
12061IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12062netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12063within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012064host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012065difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12066at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12067does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12068parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012069
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012070The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12071abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12072
12073 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12074 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12075 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12076 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12077 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12078 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12079 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12080 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12081
12082Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12083192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12084
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012085IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12086Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12087trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12088IPv6 patterns.
12089
12090HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12091following situations :
12092 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12093 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12094 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12095 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12096 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12097 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12098 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12099 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12100 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12101 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012103
121047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12105----------------------------------
12106
12107Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12108combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12109
12110 - AND (implicit)
12111 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12112 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012114A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012116 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012118Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12119indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12122"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12123requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12124is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12125
12126 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12127 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12128 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12129 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12130
12131To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12132and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12133
12134 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12135 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12136 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12137 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12138
12139 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12140 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12141 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12142 use_backend www if host_www
12143
12144It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12145expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12146be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12147the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12148
12149 The following rule :
12150
12151 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12152 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12153
12154 Can also be written that way :
12155
12156 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12157
12158It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12159to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12160simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12161sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12162good use is the following :
12163
12164 With named ACLs :
12165
12166 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12167 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12168 monitor fail if site_dead
12169
12170 With anonymous ACLs :
12171
12172 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12173
12174See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12175
12176
121777.3. Fetching samples
12178---------------------
12179
12180Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12181against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12182sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12183ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12184of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12185available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12186
12187This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12188Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12189compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12190deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12191
12192The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12193matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12194method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12195indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12196
12197As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12198when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12199mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12200the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12201ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12202
12203Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12204multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12205when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12206incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12207are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12208is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12209all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12210
12211Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12212 - name
12213 - name(arg1)
12214 - name(arg1,arg2)
12215
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012216
122177.3.1. Converters
12218-----------------
12219
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012220Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12221of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12222is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12223was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12224has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12225unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12226
12227These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12228sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12229the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12230support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012232A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12233support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12234supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12235(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12236bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012239
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001224051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12241 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12242 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12243 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12244 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12245 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12246
12247 Example :
12248 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12249 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12250 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12251 frontend http-in
12252 bind *:8081
12253 default_backend servers
12254 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12255 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012257add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012258 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012259 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012260 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12261 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12265 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12266 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12267 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012268 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012269
12270and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012271 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012272 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012273 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12274 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012275 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012276 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12277 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012281 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012282
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012283base64
12284 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12285 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12286 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12287
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012288bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012289 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012290 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12291 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12292 presence of a flag).
12293
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012294bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12295 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12296 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012297 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012298
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012299cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012300 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12301 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012302
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012303crc32([<avalanche>])
12304 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12305 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12306 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12307 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12308 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12309 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12310 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12311 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12312 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12313 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12314 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12315
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012316da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012317 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12318 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12319 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12320 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012321 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012322 configuration language.
12323
12324 Example:
12325 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012326 bind *:8881
12327 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012328 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012329
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012330debug
12331 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12332 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12333 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12334
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012335div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012336 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12337 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012338 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012339 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12340 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012341 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012342 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12343 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12345 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12346 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012347 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012349djb2([<avalanche>])
12350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12358 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012360even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012361 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012362 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12363
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012364field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12365 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12366 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12367 list of chars.
12368
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012369hex
12370 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12371 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12372 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12373 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012375http_date([<offset>])
12376 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12377 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12378 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12379 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12380 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12381 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012382
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012383in_table(<table>)
12384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12386 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12387 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12388 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12389
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012390ipmask(<mask>)
12391 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12392 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12393 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12394 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12395
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012396json([<input-code>])
12397 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12398 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012399 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012400 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12401 of errors:
12402 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12403 bytes, ...)
12404 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12405 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12406
12407 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12408 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12409 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12410 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12411 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12412 are :
12413 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12414 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12415 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12416 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12417 error ;
12418 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12419 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12420
12421 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12422 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12423
12424 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012425 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012426 capture request header user-agent len 150
12427 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012428
12429 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12430 GET / HTTP/1.0
12431 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12432
12433 Output log:
12434 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12435
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012436language(<value>[,<default>])
12437 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12438 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12439 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12440 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12441 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12442 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12443 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12444 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12445 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12446 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12447 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12448 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012449
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012450 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012452 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12453 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012455 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12456 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12457 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12458 use_backend spanish if es
12459 use_backend french if fr
12460 use_backend english if en
12461 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012462
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012463lower
12464 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12465 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12466 type. The result is of type string.
12467
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012468ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12469 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12470 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12471 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12472 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12473 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12474 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12475
12476 Example :
12477
12478 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12479 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12480 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12481
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012482map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12483map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12484map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12485 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12486 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12487 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12488 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12489 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12490 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12491 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12492 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012493
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012494 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12495 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12496 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012497
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012498 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012499 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012501 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12502 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12503 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12504 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012505 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12506 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012507 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12509 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12511 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12512 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12513 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12514 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012515 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12516 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12517 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012518 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12519 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12520 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12521 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12522 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012523
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012524 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12525 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12526 the corresponding match text.
12527
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012528 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12529 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12530 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12531 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12532 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012534 Example :
12535
12536 # this is a comment and is ignored
12537 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12538 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12539 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12540 | | | `---------- value
12541 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12542 | `---------------------------- key
12543 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12544
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012545mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012546 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12547 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012548 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012549 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012550 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012551 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12552 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12553 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12554 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12555 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012556 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012557
12558mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012559 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012560 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12561 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012562 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012563 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012564 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012565 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12566 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12568 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12569 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012570 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012571
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012572nbsrv
12573 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12574 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12575 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12576 map lookup.
12577
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012578neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012579 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12580 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12581 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12582 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012583
12584not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012585 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012586 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12587 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12588 absence of a flag).
12589
12590odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012591 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012592 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12593
12594or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012595 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012596 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012597 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12598 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012599 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012600 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12601 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12602 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12603 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012605 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012606
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012607regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012608 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12609 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12610 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12611 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12612 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12613 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12614 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12615 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12616 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12617 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012618 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12619 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12620 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12621 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012622
12623 Example :
12624
12625 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12626 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12627 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12628 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12629
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012630capture-req(<id>)
12631 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12632 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12633
12634 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012635 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12636 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012637
12638capture-res(<id>)
12639 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12640 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12641
12642 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012643 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12644 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012645
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012646sdbm([<avalanche>])
12647 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12648 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12649 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12650 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12651 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12652 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12653 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012654 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12655 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012656
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012657set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012658 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12659 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12660 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012664 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12666 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012667 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012668 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012669
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012670sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012671 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12672 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012673 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012674 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12675 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012676 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012677 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12678 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012679 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012680 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012683 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012684
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012685table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12689 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12690 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12691 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12692
12693
12694table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12697 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12698 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12699 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12700 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12701
12702table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12703 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12704 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12705 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12706 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12707 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12708
12709table_conn_cur(<table>)
12710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12712 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12713 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12714 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12715
12716table_conn_rate(<table>)
12717 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12718 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12719 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12720 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12721 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12722
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012723table_gpt0(<table>)
12724 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12725 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12726 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12727 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12728 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12729
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012730table_gpc0(<table>)
12731 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12732 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12733 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12734 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12735 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12736
12737table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12738 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12739 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12740 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12741 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12742 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12743 sample fetch keyword.
12744
12745table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12746 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12747 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12748 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12749 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12750 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12751
12752table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12753 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12754 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12755 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12756 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12757 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12758 keyword.
12759
12760table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12761 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12762 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12763 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12764 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12765 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12766
12767table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12768 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12769 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12770 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12771 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12772 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12773 keyword.
12774
12775table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12779 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12780 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12781 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12782 keyword.
12783
12784table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12788 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12789 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12790 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12791 keyword.
12792
12793table_server_id(<table>)
12794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12797 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12798 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12799 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12800
12801table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12805 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12806 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12807 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12808 keyword.
12809
12810table_sess_rate(<table>)
12811 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12812 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12813 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12814 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12815 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12816 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12817 keyword.
12818
12819table_trackers(<table>)
12820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12823 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12824 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12825 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12826 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12827 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12828 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12829 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12830
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012831upper
12832 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12833 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12834 type. The result is of type string.
12835
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012836url_dec
12837 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12838 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12839
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012840unset-var(<var name>)
12841 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12842 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12843 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12846 response),
12847 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12848 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12849 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12850 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12851
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012852utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12853 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12854 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12855 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12856 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12857 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12858 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12859
12860 Example :
12861
12862 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12863 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12864 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12865
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012866word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12867 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12868 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12869
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012870wt6([<avalanche>])
12871 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12872 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12873 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12874 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12875 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12876 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12877 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012878 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12879 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012880
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012881xor(<value>)
12882 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012883 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012884 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012885 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12888 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012889 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012890 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12891 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012892 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012893 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012894
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012895xxh32([<seed>])
12896 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12897 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12898 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12899 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12900 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12901 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12902 as cryptographically secure.
12903
12904xxh64([<seed>])
12905 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12906 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12907 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12908 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12909 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12910 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12911 as cryptographically secure.
12912
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012913
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129147.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915--------------------------------------------
12916
12917A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12918not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12919"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12920The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12921
12922always_false : boolean
12923 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12924 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12925
12926always_true : boolean
12927 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12928 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12929
12930avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012931 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012932 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12933 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12934 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12935 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12936 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12937 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12938 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12939 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12940 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12941 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12942 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12943 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12944 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012947 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12948 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12949 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12950 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12951 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12954 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12955 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12956 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12957 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12958 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12959 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012960
12961 Example :
12962 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12963 backend dynamic
12964 mode http
12965 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12966 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012967
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012968bin(<hexa>) : bin
12969 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12970 of the string.
12971
12972bool(<bool>) : bool
12973 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12974 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12977 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012978 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12980 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012981
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012982 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012983 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012984 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12985
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012986 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12987 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012988
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012989 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012990 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012992 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12993 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012995 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012996
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012997 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12998 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013000 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013001
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013002date([<offset>]) : integer
13003 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13004 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13005 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13006 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013007 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13008
13009 Example :
13010
13011 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13012 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013013
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013014env(<name>) : string
13015 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13016 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13017 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13018 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13019 certain way.
13020
13021 Examples :
13022 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13023 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13024
13025 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13026 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13029 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013030 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13031 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013032 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13033 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13034 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13035 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13036 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013037
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013038fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13040 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13041 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13044 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13045 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13046 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13047 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13048 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13049 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13050 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13051 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013052
13053 Example :
13054 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13055 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13056 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13057 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13058 frontend mail
13059 bind :25
13060 mode tcp
13061 maxconn 100
13062 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13063 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13064 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13065 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013066
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013067hostname : string
13068 Returns the system hostname.
13069
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013070int(<integer>) : signed integer
13071 Returns a signed integer.
13072
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013073ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13074 Returns an ipv4.
13075
13076ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13077 Returns an ipv6.
13078
13079meth(<method>) : method
13080 Returns a method.
13081
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013082nbproc : integer
13083 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13084 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13085 and debugging purposes.
13086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13089 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13090 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013091 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13092 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13093 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013094
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013095proc : integer
13096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13097 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13098 debugging purposes.
13099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013101 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13102 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13103 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13105 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13106 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13107 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13108 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13109
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013110rand([<range>]) : integer
13111 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13112 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13113 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13114 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13115 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13119 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13120 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13121 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13122 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13123 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13124 methods.
13125
13126srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13127 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13128 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13129 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13130 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13131 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13132 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13133 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13134
13135srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13136 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13137 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013138 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13140 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13141 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13142 overloading servers).
13143
13144 Example :
13145 # Redirect to a separate back
13146 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13147 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13148 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13149
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013150stopping : boolean
13151 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13152 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13153 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13154
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013155str(<string>) : string
13156 Returns a string.
13157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13159 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13160 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13161
13162table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13163 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13164 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13165 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13166
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013167var(<var-name>) : undefined
13168 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013169 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13170 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013171 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013172 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13173 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013174 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13176 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013177 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013178 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181----------------------------------
13182
13183The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13184closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13185methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13186sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13187TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013188the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13189counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13190"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013191argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13192the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13193this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194
13195be_id : integer
13196 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13197 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13198
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013199be_name : string
13200 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13201 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203dst : ip
13204 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13205 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13206 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13207 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13208 RFC 4291.
13209
13210dst_conn : integer
13211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13212 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13213 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13214 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13215 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13216 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13217 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13218 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013219
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013220dst_is_local : boolean
13221 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13222 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13223 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13224 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13225 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13226 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13227 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13228 it only once per connection.
13229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013230dst_port : integer
13231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13232 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13233 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13234 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13235 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13236 an HTTP header.
13237
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013238fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13239 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13240 header.
13241
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013242fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13243 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13244 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13245 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13246 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13247 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13248 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13249
13250fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13251 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13252 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13253 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13254 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13255 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13256 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13257
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013258fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13259 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13260 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13261 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13262 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13263
13264fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13265 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13266 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13267 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13268 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13269
13270fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13271 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13272 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13273 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13274 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13275
13276fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13277 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13278 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13279 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13280 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13281
13282fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13283 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13284 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13285 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13286 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13287
13288fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13289 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13290 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13291 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13292 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294fe_id : integer
13295 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013296 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13298
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013299fe_name : string
13300 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13301 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13302 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13303
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013304sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013305sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13306sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13307sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013308 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13309 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13310 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13311
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013312sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013313sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13314sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13315sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013316 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13317 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13318 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013320sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013321sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13322sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13323sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013324 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13325 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013326 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13327 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13328 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013329
13330 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13331 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013332 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13333 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13334 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013335 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13336 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013338sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013339sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13340sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13341sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013342 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13343 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013345sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013346sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13347sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13348sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013349 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13350 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13351 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13352
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013353sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013354sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13355sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13356sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013357 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13358 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13359 See also src_conn_rate.
13360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013361sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013362sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13363sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13364sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013365 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013366 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013367
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013368sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13369sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13370sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13371sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13372 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13373 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13374
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013375sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013376sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13377sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13378sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013379 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13380 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13381 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013382 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13383 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13384 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013386sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013387sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13388sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13389sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013390 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13391 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13392 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013394sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013395sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13396sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13397sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013398 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13399 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13400 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13401 src_http_err_rate.
13402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013403sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013404sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13405sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13406sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013407 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13408 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13409 src_http_req_cnt.
13410
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013411sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013412sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13413sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13414sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013415 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13416 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13417 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13418 src_http_req_rate.
13419
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013420sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013421sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13422sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13423sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013424 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013425 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13426 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13427 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13428 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013429
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013430 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13431 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013432 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13433
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013434sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013435sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13436sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13437sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013438 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13439 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13440 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013441
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013442sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013443sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13444sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13445sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013446 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13447 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13448 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013449
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013450sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013451sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13452sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13453sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013454 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13455 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13456 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13457 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013458 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013459 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013461sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013462sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13463sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13464sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013465 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13466 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13467 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13468 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13469 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013470 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013471
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013472sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013473sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13474sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13475sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013476 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13477 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13478 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013480sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013481sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13482sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13483sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013484 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13485 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013486 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013487 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13488 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13490 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13491 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493so_id : integer
13494 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13495 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13496 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498src : ip
13499 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13500 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13501 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13502 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013503 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13504 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13505 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13506 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013507
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013508 Example:
13509 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13510 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013512src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13513 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13514 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13515 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013516 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13519 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13520 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013521 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013522 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013524src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13525 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13526 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13527 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13528 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13529 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13530 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013531
13532 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13533 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13534 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13535 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013536 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013537 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13538 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013541 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013543 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013544 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013547 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13549 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013550 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13553 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13554 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13555 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013556 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013559 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013560 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013561 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013562 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013563
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013564src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13565 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13566 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13567 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13568 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013570src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013571 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013573 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13574 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013575 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13576 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13577 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13580 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13581 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013582 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013583 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013584 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13587 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13588 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13589 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13590 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013591 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13594 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13595 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13596 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013597 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13600 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13601 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13602 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013603 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013604 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013606src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13607 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13608 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13609 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013610 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013611 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13612 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013613
13614 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013615 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013616 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013617
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013618src_is_local : boolean
13619 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13620 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13621 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13622 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13623 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13624 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13625 once per connection.
13626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013627src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013628 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13629 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13630 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13631 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13632 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013634src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013635 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13636 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13637 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13638 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13639 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013641src_port : integer
13642 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13643 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13644 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13645 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13648 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013649 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13650 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13651 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013652 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13655 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13656 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13657 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13658 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013659 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13662 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13663 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13664 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13665 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13666 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13667 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13668 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13669 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013670
13671 Example :
13672 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13673 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13674 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13675 listen ssh
13676 bind :22
13677 mode tcp
13678 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013679 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013681 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683srv_id : integer
13684 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13685 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13686 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013687
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013689----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13692closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13693when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13694usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013695future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013696
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001369751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13698 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13699 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13700 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13701 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13702 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13703
13704 Example :
13705 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13706 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13707 # the request.
13708 frontend http-in
13709 bind *:8081
13710 default_backend servers
13711 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13712 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13713
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013714ssl_bc : boolean
13715 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13716 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13717 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13718
13719ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13720 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13721 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13722
13723ssl_bc_cipher : string
13724 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13725 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13726
13727ssl_bc_protocol : string
13728 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13729 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13730
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013731ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013732 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013733 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13734 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013735
13736ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13737 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13738 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13739 if session was reused or not.
13740
13741ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13742 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13743 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13746 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13747 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13748 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13749 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13750 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13753 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13754 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13755 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13756 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013757
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013758ssl_c_der : binary
13759 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13760 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13761 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763ssl_c_err : integer
13764 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13765 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13766 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13767 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13768 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13771 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13772 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13773 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13774 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13775 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13776 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13777 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13778 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780ssl_c_key_alg : string
13781 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13782 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13783 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013785ssl_c_notafter : string
13786 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13787 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13788 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790ssl_c_notbefore : string
13791 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13792 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13793 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13796 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13797 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13798 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13799 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13800 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13801 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13802 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13803 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013805ssl_c_serial : binary
13806 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13807 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13808 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13811 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13812 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13813 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013814 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13815 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13816
13817 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013819ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13820 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13821 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13822 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824ssl_c_used : boolean
13825 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13826 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013828ssl_c_verify : integer
13829 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13830 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13831 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13832 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013834ssl_c_version : integer
13835 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13836 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013837
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013838ssl_f_der : binary
13839 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13840 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13841 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013843ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13844 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13845 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13846 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13847 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013848 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13850 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13851 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013853ssl_f_key_alg : string
13854 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13855 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13856 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858ssl_f_notafter : string
13859 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13860 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13861 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863ssl_f_notbefore : string
13864 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13865 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13866 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13869 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13870 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13871 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13872 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13873 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13874 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13875 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13876 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013878ssl_f_serial : binary
13879 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13880 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13881 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013882
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013883ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13884 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13885 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13886 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13889 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13890 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13891 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013893ssl_f_version : integer
13894 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13895 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13896
13897ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013898 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13899 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13900 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902 Example :
13903 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13904 listen http-https
13905 bind :80
13906 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13907 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13908
13909ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13910 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13911 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13912
13913ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013914 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13916 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13917 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13918 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13919 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13920 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13921 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13922 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924ssl_fc_cipher : string
13925 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13926 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013927
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013928ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
13929 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
13930 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013931 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013932
13933ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
13934 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
13935 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013936 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013937
13938ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
13939 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
13940 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
13941 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
13942 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
13943 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
13944 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
13945
13946ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
13947 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
13948 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013949 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013952 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13953 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013954 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13955 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13956 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13957 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13960 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013961 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13962 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13963 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13964 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013965
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013966ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013967 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13968 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013971 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13973 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13974 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13975 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13976 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13977 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13978 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980ssl_fc_protocol : string
13981 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13982 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013983
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013984ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013985 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013986 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13987 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13990 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13991 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13992 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13993 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013995ssl_fc_sni : string
13996 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13997 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13998 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13999 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14000 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14001
14002 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14003 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14004 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014005 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14006 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14010 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014012ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14013 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14014 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014015
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140177.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014020Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14021sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14022only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14023For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14024be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14025can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14026sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14027for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14028content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14031 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14032 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14033 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14036 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14037 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14038 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040req.len : integer
14041req_len : integer (deprecated)
14042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14043 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14044 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14045 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14046 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14047 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14048 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14049 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14052 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014053 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14054 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14055 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14056 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014058 ACL alternatives :
14059 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14062 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14063 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14064 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14065 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014067 ACL alternatives :
14068 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014072req.proto_http : boolean
14073req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14074 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14075 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14076 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14077 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14078 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14079 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14080 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 Example:
14083 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14084 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14085 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014086 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14089rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14090 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14091 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14092 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14093 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14094 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14095 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14096 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14099 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14100 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14101 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14102 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14103 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105 ACL derivatives :
14106 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108 Example :
14109 listen tse-farm
14110 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14111 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14112 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14113 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14114 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14115 persist rdp-cookie
14116 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14117 # This is only useful makes sense if
14118 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14119 stick-table type string size 204800
14120 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14121 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14122 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14125 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014127req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14128rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14129 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14130 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14131 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14132 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134 ACL derivatives :
14135 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014136
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014137req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14138 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14139 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014140 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14141 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14142 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14143 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14144 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14147req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14148 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14149 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14150 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14151 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14152 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14153 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14154 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156req.ssl_sni : string
14157req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14158 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14159 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14160 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14161 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14162 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14163 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14164 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14165 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14166 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14167 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14168 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14169 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171 ACL derivatives :
14172 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174 Examples :
14175 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14176 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14177 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14178 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14179 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014180
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014181req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14182 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14183 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14184 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14185 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14186 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14187 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14188 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14189 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14190 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014192req.ssl_ver : integer
14193req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14194 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14195 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14196 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14197 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14198 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14199 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14200 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14201 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14202 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204 ACL derivatives :
14205 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014206
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014207res.len : integer
14208 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14209 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14210 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14211 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14212 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14213 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14214 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14215 content inspection.
14216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14218 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014219 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14220 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14221 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14222 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14225 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14226 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14227 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14228 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014231
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014232res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14233rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14234 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14235 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14236 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14237 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14238 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14239 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14240 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242wait_end : boolean
14243 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14244 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14245 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14246 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14247 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14248 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14249 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14250 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 Examples :
14253 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14254 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14255 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14258 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14259 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14260 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14261 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14262 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14263 tcp-request content reject
14264
14265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142667.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267--------------------------------------
14268
14269It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14270This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14271data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14272its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14273HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14274content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14275to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14276more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14277response are indexed.
14278
14279base : string
14280 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14281 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14282 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14283 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14284 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14285 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14286 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14287 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14288
14289 ACL derivatives :
14290 base : exact string match
14291 base_beg : prefix match
14292 base_dir : subdir match
14293 base_dom : domain match
14294 base_end : suffix match
14295 base_len : length match
14296 base_reg : regex match
14297 base_sub : substring match
14298
14299base32 : integer
14300 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14301 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14302 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014303 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14304 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14305 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306
14307base32+src : binary
14308 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14309 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14310 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14311 per-URL counters.
14312
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014313capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14314 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14315 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14316 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14317
14318capture.req.method : string
14319 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14320 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14321 because it's allocated.
14322
14323capture.req.uri : string
14324 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14325 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14326 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14327 allocated.
14328
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014329capture.req.ver : string
14330 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14331 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14332 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14333
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014334capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14335 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14336 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14337 The first entry is an index of 0.
14338 See also: "capture response header"
14339
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014340capture.res.ver : string
14341 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14342 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14343 persistent flag.
14344
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014345req.body : binary
14346 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14347 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14348 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14349 the first chunk is analyzed.
14350
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014351req.body_param([<name>) : string
14352 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14353 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14354 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14355 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14356 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14357 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14358 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14359 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14360 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14361 given.
14362
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014363req.body_len : integer
14364 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14365 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14366 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14367 "option http-buffer-request".
14368
14369req.body_size : integer
14370 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14371 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14372 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14373 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14374 "option http-buffer-request".
14375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376req.cook([<name>]) : string
14377cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14378 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14379 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14380 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14381 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14382 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14383 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14384 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14385 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14386
14387 ACL derivatives :
14388 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14389 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14390 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14391 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14392 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14393 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14394 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14395 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14398cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14399 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14400 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14403cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14404 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14405 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14406 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14407 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14410 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14411 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14412 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14413 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014414 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14416 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14417 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14418 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14421 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14422 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14423 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14424 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014425 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014427req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14428 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14429 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14430 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14431 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14432 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14433 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14434 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14435 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14438 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14439 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14440 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14441 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14444 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14445 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14446 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14447 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14448 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14449 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14450 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14451 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14452 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14453 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14454 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456 ACL derivatives :
14457 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14458 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14459 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14460 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14461 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14462 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14463 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14464 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14465
14466req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14467hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14468 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14469 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14470 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14471 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14472 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14473 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14474 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14475 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14476 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14477
14478req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14479hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14480 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14481 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14482 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14483 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14484 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14485 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14486 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14487 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14488
14489req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14490hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14491 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14492 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14493 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14494 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14495 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14496 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14497 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14498
14499http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14500 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14501 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14502 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14503 basic auth is supported.
14504
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014505http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14506 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14507 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14508 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14509 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14511 basic auth is supported.
14512
14513 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014514 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14515 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14516 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14517 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014518
14519http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014520 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14521 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14523 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525method : integer + string
14526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14527 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14528 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14529 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14530 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14531 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14532 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534 ACL derivatives :
14535 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 Example :
14538 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14539 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14540 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542path : string
14543 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14544 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14545 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14546 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14547 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14548 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14549 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551 ACL derivatives :
14552 path : exact string match
14553 path_beg : prefix match
14554 path_dir : subdir match
14555 path_dom : domain match
14556 path_end : suffix match
14557 path_len : length match
14558 path_reg : regex match
14559 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014560
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014561query : string
14562 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14563 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14564 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14565 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014566 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014567 which stops before the question mark.
14568
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014569req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14570 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14571 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14572 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14573 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575req.ver : string
14576req_ver : string (deprecated)
14577 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14578 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14579 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581 ACL derivatives :
14582 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584res.comp : boolean
14585 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14586 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14587 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589res.comp_algo : string
14590 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14591 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14592 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594res.cook([<name>]) : string
14595scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14596 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14597 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14598 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014600 ACL derivatives :
14601 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14604scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14605 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14606 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14607 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14610scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14611 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14612 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14613 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14616 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14617 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14618 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14619 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14620 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14621 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14622 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14623 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14624 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14627 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14628 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14629 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14630 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14631 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14634shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14635 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14636 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14637 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14638 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14639 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14640 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14641 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14642 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644 ACL derivatives :
14645 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14646 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14647 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14648 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14649 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14650 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14651 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14652 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14653
14654res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14655shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14656 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14657 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14658 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14659 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14660 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14663shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14664 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14665 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14666 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14667 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14668 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14669 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014670
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014671res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14672 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14673 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14674 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14675 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14678shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14679 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14680 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14681 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14682 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14683 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14684 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014686res.ver : string
14687resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14688 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14689 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014691 ACL derivatives :
14692 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14695 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14696 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014697 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014698 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14701 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703status : integer
14704 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14705 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14706 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014707
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014708unique-id : string
14709 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14710 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14711 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14712 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14713 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14714 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716url : string
14717 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14718 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14719 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14720 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14721 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14722 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14723 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725 ACL derivatives :
14726 url : exact string match
14727 url_beg : prefix match
14728 url_dir : subdir match
14729 url_dom : domain match
14730 url_end : suffix match
14731 url_len : length match
14732 url_reg : regex match
14733 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735url_ip : ip
14736 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14737 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14738 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14739 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14740 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14741 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14742 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744url_port : integer
14745 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14746 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14747 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14748 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014749
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014750urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14751url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014752 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14753 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014754 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14755 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14756 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14757 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14759 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014760 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14761 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763 ACL derivatives :
14764 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14765 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14766 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14767 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14768 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14769 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14770 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14771 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014772
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 Example :
14775 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14776 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14777 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14778 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014779
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014780urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14782 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14783 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014784
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014785url32 : integer
14786 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14787 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14788 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14789 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14790 is an unsigned integer.
14791
14792url32+src : binary
14793 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14794 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14795 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14796
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014799---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014801Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14802every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014803order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014805ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14806---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014807FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014808HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14810HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014811HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14812HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14813HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14814HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14815LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014816METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014817METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14819METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14820METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14821METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014822METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014823METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014824RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014825REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014826TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014827WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14828---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014829
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148318. Logging
14832----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014834One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14835provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14836very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14837provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14838state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014839to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014840headers.
14841
14842In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14843about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14844send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14845
14846 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14847 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14848 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14849 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14850 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014851 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14852 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014853
14854The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14855allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14856as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14857while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14858real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14859delay.
14860
14861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148628.1. Log levels
14863---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014864
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014865TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014866source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014867HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14868in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14869track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14870syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14871about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014872
14873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148748.2. Log formats
14875----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014877HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014878and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14879slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14880options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014881
14882 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14883 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14884 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14885 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14886 extents.
14887
14888 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14889 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14890 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14891 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14892 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14893
14894 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14895 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14896 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14897 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14898 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14899
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014900 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14901 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14902 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14903 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14904
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014905 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14906
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014907Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14908specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14909field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14910servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14911always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14912identifier.
14913
14914Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14915 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14916 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14917 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14918 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14919
14920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149218.2.1. Default log format
14922-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014923
14924This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14925as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14926format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14927
14928 Example :
14929 listen www
14930 mode http
14931 log global
14932 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14933
14934 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14935 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14936 (www/HTTP)
14937
14938 Field Format Extract from the example above
14939 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14940 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14941 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14942 4 'to' to
14943 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14944 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14945
14946Detailed fields description :
14947 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14948 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14949 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14950 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14951 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14952 and processed the connection.
14953 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14954
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014955In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14956"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14957connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14958
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014959It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14960will eventually disappear.
14961
14962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149638.2.2. TCP log format
14964---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014965
14966The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14967is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14968information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14969counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14970emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14971environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14972the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14973sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014974specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14975not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14976fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14977marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014978
14979 Example :
14980 frontend fnt
14981 mode tcp
14982 option tcplog
14983 log global
14984 default_backend bck
14985
14986 backend bck
14987 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14988
14989 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14990 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14991 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14992
14993 Field Format Extract from the example above
14994 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14995 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14996 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14997 4 frontend_name fnt
14998 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14999 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15000 7 bytes_read* 212
15001 8 termination_state --
15002 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15003 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15004
15005Detailed fields description :
15006 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015007 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15008 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15009 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015010 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15011 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15012 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015013
15014 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015015 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15016 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15017 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015018
15019 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15020 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15021 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15022 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15023
15024 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15025 and processed the connection.
15026
15027 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15028 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15029 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15030 applications.
15031
15032 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15033 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15034 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15035 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15036 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15037
15038 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15039 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15040 See "Timers" below for more details.
15041
15042 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15043 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15044 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15045 "Timers" below for more details.
15046
15047 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015048 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015049 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15050 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15051 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15052 details.
15053
15054 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15055 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15056 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15057 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15058 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15059
15060 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15061 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15062 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15063 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15064 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15065 for more details.
15066
15067 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015068 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015069 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15070 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15071 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015072 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015073
15074 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15075 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15076 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15077 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15078 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15079 caused by a denial of service attack.
15080
15081 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15082 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15083 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15084 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15085 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15086 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15087 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15088 denial of service attack.
15089
15090 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15091 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15092 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15093 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15094 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15095 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15096 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15097 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15098 be processed than on other servers.
15099
15100 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15101 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15102 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15103 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15104 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15105 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15106 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15107 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15108 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15109 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15110 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15111 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15112 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15113
15114 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15115 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15116 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15117 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15118 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15119 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15120 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15121 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15122
15123 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15124 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15125 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15126 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15127 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15128 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15129 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15130 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15131 occurs.
15132
15133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151348.2.3. HTTP log format
15135----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015136
15137The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15138is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15139the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15140are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15141emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15142generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15143"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15144which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015145frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15146is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015147
15148Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15149slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15150with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15151
15152 Example :
15153 frontend http-in
15154 mode http
15155 option httplog
15156 log global
15157 default_backend bck
15158
15159 backend static
15160 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15161
15162 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15163 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15164 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015165 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015166
15167 Field Format Extract from the example above
15168 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15169 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015170 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015171 4 frontend_name http-in
15172 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015173 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015174 7 status_code 200
15175 8 bytes_read* 2750
15176 9 captured_request_cookie -
15177 10 captured_response_cookie -
15178 11 termination_state ----
15179 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15180 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15181 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15182 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15183 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015184
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015185Detailed fields description :
15186 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015187 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15188 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15189 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015190 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15191 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15192 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015193
15194 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015195 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15196 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15197 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015199 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15200 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015201
15202 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15203 and processed the connection.
15204
15205 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15206 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15207 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15208
15209 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15210 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15211 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15212 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15213 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15214 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15215
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015216 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15217 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15218 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15219 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15220 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15221 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15222 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015223
15224 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15225 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15226 See "Timers" below for more details.
15227
15228 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15229 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15230 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15231 below for more details.
15232
15233 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15234 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15235 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15236 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15237 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15238 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15239 for more details.
15240
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015241 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15242 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15243 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15244 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15245 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15246 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15247 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15248 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015249
15250 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15251 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15252 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15253
15254 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15255 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15256 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15257 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15258 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15259 overflowing.
15260
15261 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15262 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15263 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15264 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15265 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15266 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15267 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15268 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15269
15270 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15271 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15272 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15273 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15274 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15275 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15276 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15277 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15278
15279 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15280 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15281 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15282 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15283 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15284 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15285 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15286
15287 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015288 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015289 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15290 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15291 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015292 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015293 system.
15294
15295 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15296 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15297 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15298 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15299 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15300 caused by a denial of service attack.
15301
15302 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15303 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15304 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15305 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15306 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15307 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15308 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15309 denial of service attack.
15310
15311 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15312 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15313 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15314 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15315 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15316 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15317 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15318 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15319 processed than on other servers.
15320
15321 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15322 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15323 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15324 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15325 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15326 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15327 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15328 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15329 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15330 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15331 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15332 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15333 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15334
15335 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15336 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15337 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15338 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15339 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15340 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15341 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15342 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15343
15344 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15345 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15346 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15347 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15348 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15349 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15350 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15351 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15352 occurs.
15353
15354 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15355 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15356 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15357 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15358 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15359 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15360 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15361 cookies" below for more details.
15362
15363 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15364 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15365 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15366 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15367 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15368 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15369 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15370 and cookies" below for more details.
15371
15372 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15373 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15374 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15375 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15376 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15377 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15378 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15379 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15380
15381
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200153828.2.4. Custom log format
15383------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015384
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015385The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015386mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015387
15388HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15389Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15390separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15391prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15392
15393Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15394variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015395("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015396
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015397If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015398as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015399less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15400the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15401
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015402Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015403In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015404in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015405
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015406Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15407'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15408https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15409such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15410
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015411Flags are :
15412 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015413 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015414 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15415 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015416
15417 Example:
15418
15419 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15421
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015422 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15423
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015424At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15425
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015426 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15427 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015428
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015429the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015431 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15432 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15433 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015434
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015435and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15436
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015437 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15438 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015440Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15441
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015442 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015443 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015444 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15445 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15446 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015447 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15448 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15449 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015450 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015451 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15452 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015453 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015454 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15455 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015456 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015457 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015458 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015459 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015460 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015461 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015462 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015463 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15464 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15465 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15466 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15467 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015468 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015469 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15470 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015471 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015472 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15473 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015474 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15475 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15476 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015477 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015478 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15479 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015480 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015481 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15482 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15483 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015484 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015485 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015486 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15487 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15488 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15489 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015490 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015491 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015492 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015493 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015494 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015495 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015496 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15497 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15498 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015499 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015500 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15501 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015502 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015503 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15504 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15505 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015506 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015507 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015508 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015509
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015510 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015511
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015512
155138.2.5. Error log format
15514-----------------------
15515
15516When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15517protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15518By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15519"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15520will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15521logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15522
15523The format looks like this :
15524
15525 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15526 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15527 Connection error during SSL handshake
15528
15529 Field Format Extract from the example above
15530 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15531 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15532 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15533 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15534 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15535
15536These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15537failures.
15538
15539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155408.3. Advanced logging options
15541-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015542
15543Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15544just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15545options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15546for more information about their usage.
15547
15548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155498.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15550------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015551
15552It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15553haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15554commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15555monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15556ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15557
15558 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15559 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15560 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15561 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15562
15563 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15564 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15565 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015566 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015567 such as other load-balancers.
15568
15569 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15570 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15571 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15572
15573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155748.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15575----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015576
15577The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15578what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15579or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15580"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15581just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15582log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15583after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15584is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15585with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15586with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15587
15588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155898.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15590------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015591
15592Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15593for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15594"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15595retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15596raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15597a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15598file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15599you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15600"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15601
15602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15604--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015605
15606Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15607multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15608them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15609"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15610logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15611error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15612and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15613too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15614useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15615alternative.
15616
15617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156188.4. Timing events
15619------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015620
15621Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15622reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15623the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15624frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015625mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15626addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15627
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015628Timings events in HTTP mode:
15629
15630 first request 2nd request
15631 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15632 t tr t tr ...
15633 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15634 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15635 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15636 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15637 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15638
15639Timings events in TCP mode:
15640
15641 TCP session
15642 |<----------------->|
15643 t t
15644 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15645 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15646 |<------ Tt ------->|
15647
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015648 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15649 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15650 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15651 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15652 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15653 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15654 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015655
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015656 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15657 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15658 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15659 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15660 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15661 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15662 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15663 nothing was received on the connection.
15664
15665 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15666 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15667 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15668 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15669 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15670 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15671 request typed by hand during a test.
15672
15673 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15674 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15675 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15676 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15677 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15678 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15679 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015680
15681 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15682 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15683 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15684 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15685 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15686
15687 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15688 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15689 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15690 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15691 connection never established.
15692
15693 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15694 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15695 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15696 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15697 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15698 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15699 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15700 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15701 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15702 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15703 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015705 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15706 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15707 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15708 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15709 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15710 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15711
15712 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15713
15714 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15715 "Ta" can never be negative.
15716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15718 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015719 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15720 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015721 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015722
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015723 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015724
15725 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015726 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15727 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015728
15729These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15730protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15731that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015732due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15733"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15734that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735
15736Most common cases :
15737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015738 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15739 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15740 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15741 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15742 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15743 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15744 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15745 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15746 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15747 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15748 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015749 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015750
15751 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15752 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15753 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15754 of ms on remote networks.
15755
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015756 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15757 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15758 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015759
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015760 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15761 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15762 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15763 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15764 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15765 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15766 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15767 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15768 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015769
15770Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15771
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015772 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015773 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015774 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015775
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015776 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015777 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15778 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15779
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015780 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015781 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15782 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15783 flags.
15784
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015785 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15786 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015787 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15788 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15789 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15790 the client connection was maintained open.
15791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015792 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015793 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015794 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015795 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15796
15797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157988.5. Session state at disconnection
15799-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015800
15801TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15802"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
158032-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15804each of which has a special meaning :
15805
15806 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15807 session to terminate :
15808
15809 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15810
15811 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15812 server explicitly refused it.
15813
15814 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15815 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15816 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15817 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015818 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15819
15820 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15821 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015822
15823 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15824 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15825 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15826 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15827 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15828
15829 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15830 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15831 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15832 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15833 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15834
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015835 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15836 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15837
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015838 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15839 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15840 backup connections when going up.
15841
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015842 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15843
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015844 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15845 send or receive data.
15846
15847 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15848 send or receive data.
15849
15850 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15851 with nothing left in the buffers.
15852
15853 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15854
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015855 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015856 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15857
15858 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15859 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15860 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15861 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15862 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15863
15864 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15865 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15866
15867 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15868 server (HTTP only).
15869
15870 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15871
15872 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15873 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15874 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15875
15876 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15877 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15878 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15879
15880 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15881
15882 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15883 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15884
15885 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15886 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15887 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15888
15889 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15890 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015891 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15892 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015893
15894 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15895 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15896 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15897 another server.
15898
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015899 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015900 server.
15901
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015902 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15903 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15904 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15905 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15906
15907 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15908 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15909 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15910 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15911
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015912 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15913 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15914 "use-server" rule).
15915
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015916 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15917
15918 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15919 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15920
15921 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15922
15923 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15924 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15925 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15926
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015927 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15928 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015929 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015930 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15931 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15932
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015933 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15934
15935 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15936 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15937
15938 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15939
15940 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15941
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015942The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15943was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015944helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15945starvation, attacks, etc...
15946
15947The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15948alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15949easier finding and understanding.
15950
15951 Flags Reason
15952
15953 -- Normal termination.
15954
15955 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15956 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15957 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15958 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15959
15960 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15961 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15962 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15963 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15964 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15965 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015966
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015967 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15968 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015969 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015970
15971 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15972 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15973 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15974
15975 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15976 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15977 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15978 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15979 the server takes too long to respond.
15980
15981 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15982 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15983 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15984 long a time to respond.
15985
15986 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15987 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15988 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15989 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015990 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15991 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015992
15993 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15994 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15995 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15996 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15997 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015998 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015999 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16000 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16001 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16002 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16003 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16004 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16005 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16006 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16007 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16008 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16009 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16010 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016011
16012 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16013 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016014 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16015 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16016 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16017 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016018
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016019 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16020 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016022 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016023 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16024 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16025 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16026 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16027 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16028
16029 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16030 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16031 503 or 504 here.
16032
16033 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16034 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16035 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16036 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16037 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16038
16039 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16040 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016041 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016042 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16043 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16044
16045 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16046 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16047 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16048 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16049 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16050 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16051 between haproxy and the server.
16052
16053 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16054 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16055 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16056 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16057 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16058 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16059 solution is to fix the application.
16060
16061 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16062 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16063 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16064 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16065 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16066 external attacks.
16067
16068 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16069 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016070 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016071 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16072 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16073
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016074 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16075 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16076 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016077 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16078 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016080 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16081 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16082 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16083 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016084 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16085 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16086 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16087 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16088 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016089
16090 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16091 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16092 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16093 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16094
16095 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16096 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16097 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16098 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16099
16100 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16101 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16102 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16103 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16104
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016105The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16106persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16107important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16108re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16109
16110 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16111
16112 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16113 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16114 set on a GET request.
16115
16116 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16117 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016118 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016119 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16120
16121 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16122 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16123 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16124
16125 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16126 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16127 already got a cookie.
16128
16129 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16130 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16131 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16132 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16133 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16134
16135 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16136 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16137 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16138
16139 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16140 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16141 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16142
16143 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16144 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16145
16146 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16147 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16148 then advertised in the response.
16149
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161518.6. Non-printable characters
16152-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016153
16154In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16155consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16156converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16157prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16158being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16159escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16160is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16161'}' when logging headers.
16162
16163Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16164issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16165containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16166
16167Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16168the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16169performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16170
16171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161728.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16173---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016174
16175Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16176achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016177section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16179the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16180the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016181locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016182not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16183user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16184a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16185wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16186
16187 Examples :
16188 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16189 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16190
16191 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16192 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16193
16194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161958.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16196---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016197
16198Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16199proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16200the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16201server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16202
16203Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16204response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016205section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016206
16207It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016208time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16209appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016210are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16211and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16212follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16213request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16214in the logs.
16215
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016216As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16217frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16218an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016220 Example :
16221 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16222 listen proxy-out
16223 mode http
16224 option httplog
16225 option logasap
16226 log global
16227 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16228
16229 # log the name of the virtual server
16230 capture request header Host len 20
16231
16232 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16233 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16234
16235 # log the beginning of the referrer
16236 capture request header Referer len 20
16237
16238 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16239 capture response header Server len 20
16240
16241 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16242 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16243
16244 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16245 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16246
16247 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16248 capture response header Via len 20
16249
16250 # log the URL location during a redirection
16251 capture response header Location len 20
16252
16253 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16254 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16255 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16256 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16257 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16258
16259 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16260 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16261 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16262 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016263 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016264
16265 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16266 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16267 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16268 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16269 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016270 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016271
16272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162738.9. Examples of logs
16274---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275
16276These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16277them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16278reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16279
16280 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16281 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16282 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16283
16284 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16285 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16286
16287 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16288 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16289 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16290
16291 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16292 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16293
16294 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16295 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16296 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16297
16298 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016299 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016300 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16301 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16302
16303 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16304 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16305 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16306
16307 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16308 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016309 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016310 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16311 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16312 to return the 502 and not the server.
16313
16314 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016315 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316
16317 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16318 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16319 Nothing was sent to any server.
16320
16321 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16322 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16323
16324 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16325 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16326 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16327 send a 408 return code to the client.
16328
16329 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16330 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16331
16332 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16333 5 seconds ("c----").
16334
16335 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16336 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016337 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338
16339 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016340 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016341 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16342 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16343 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16344 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16345 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016346
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016347
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200163489. Supported filters
16349--------------------
16350
16351Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16352accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16353unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16354
16355See also : "filter"
16356
163579.1. Trace
16358----------
16359
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016360filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016361
16362 Arguments:
16363 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16364 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16365
16366 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16367 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16368 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16369 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16370
16371 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16372 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16373 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16374 amount of the parsed data.
16375
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016376 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16377
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016378This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16379callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16380information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16381filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16382
16383Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16384tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16385a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16386
16387
163889.2. HTTP compression
16389---------------------
16390
16391filter compression
16392
16393The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16394keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16395when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16396use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16397used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16398filters evaluation order.
16399
16400See also : "compression"
16401
16402
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200164039.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16404--------------------------------------------
16405
16406filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16407
16408 Arguments :
16409
16410 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16411 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16412 parsed.
16413
16414 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16415 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16416 part must be placed in its own scope.
16417
16418The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16419external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16420streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16421exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16422also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16423
16424SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16425the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16426
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016427For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016428"doc/SPOE.txt".
16429
16430Important note:
16431 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16432 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016434/*
16435 * Local variables:
16436 * fill-column: 79
16437 * End:
16438 */